1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.89"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
755 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
785 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2420 This is a test message.
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2794 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2796 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2797 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2798 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2799 of a file. For example:
2801 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2803 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2804 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2805 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2806 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2807 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2808 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2809 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2812 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2814 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2815 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2816 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2817 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2818 system filters are recognized.
2820 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2822 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2824 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2825 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2826 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2827 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2828 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2829 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2832 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2833 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2834 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2836 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2838 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2839 variables that are used by the user filter.
2841 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2846 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2847 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2848 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2851 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2852 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2853 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2854 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2856 When testing a filter file,
2857 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2858 .cindex "envelope sender"
2859 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2860 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2861 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2862 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2863 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2866 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2868 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2869 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2870 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2873 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2875 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2876 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2877 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2878 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2879 actually being delivered.
2881 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2883 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2884 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2887 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2889 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2890 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2893 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2895 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2896 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2897 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2898 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2899 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2900 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2901 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2902 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2903 after a full stop. For example:
2905 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2906 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2908 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2909 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2910 conversion to the canonical form is
2911 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2913 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2914 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2915 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2916 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2917 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2921 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2922 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2923 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2926 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2927 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2928 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2930 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2931 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2932 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2933 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2934 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2935 session were authenticated.
2937 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2938 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2939 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2941 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2942 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2943 specialized SMTP test program such as
2944 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2946 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2948 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2949 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2950 updating the callout cache database.
2954 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2955 .cindex "building alias file"
2956 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2957 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2958 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2959 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2960 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2963 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2964 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2965 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2966 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2967 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2968 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2971 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2973 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2974 .cindex "querying exim information"
2975 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2976 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2977 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2978 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2979 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2982 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2983 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2984 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2985 recognised DSCP names.
2987 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2988 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2989 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2990 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2991 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2992 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2993 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2994 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2995 way to guarantee a correct response.
2999 .cindex "local message reception"
3000 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3001 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3002 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3003 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3004 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3005 if no other conflicting option is present.
3007 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3008 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3009 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3010 suppressing this for special cases.
3012 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3013 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3015 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3016 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3017 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3020 .cindex "message" "format"
3021 .cindex "format" "message"
3022 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3023 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3024 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3025 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3026 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3028 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3029 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3031 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3032 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3033 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3034 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3035 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3037 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3038 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3039 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3040 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3041 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3043 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3044 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3045 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3046 .cindex "malware scan test"
3047 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3048 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3049 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3050 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3051 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3052 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3053 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3055 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3056 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3057 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3058 This option requires admin privileges.
3060 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3061 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3062 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3066 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3067 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3068 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3069 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3070 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3071 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3072 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3074 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3075 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3076 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3077 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3078 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3080 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3081 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3082 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3083 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3089 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3090 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3091 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3092 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3093 arguments, for example:
3095 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3097 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3098 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3099 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3100 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3101 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3102 users, the output is as in this example:
3104 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3106 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3107 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3109 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3110 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3111 backward compatibility.)
3112 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3113 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3115 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3116 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3117 name will not be output.
3119 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3120 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3121 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3122 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3123 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3124 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3125 written directly into the spool directory.
3127 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3129 exim -bP +local_domains
3131 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3132 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3134 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3135 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3136 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3137 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3138 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3139 that driver are output. For example:
3141 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3143 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3144 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3145 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3146 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3147 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3150 .cindex "environment"
3151 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3152 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3155 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3156 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3157 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3158 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3159 The output format is one item per line.
3163 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3164 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3165 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3166 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3167 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3168 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3169 to allow any user to see the queue.
3171 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3173 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3174 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3177 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3178 .cindex "size" "of message"
3179 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3180 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3181 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3182 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3183 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3184 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3185 before the sender address.
3187 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3188 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3189 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3191 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3192 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3193 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3194 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3195 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3201 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3202 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3203 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3209 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3210 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3211 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3212 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3217 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3218 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3219 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3220 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3224 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3228 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3233 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3234 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3235 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3236 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3241 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3242 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3243 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3244 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3245 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3247 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3248 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3250 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3251 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3252 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3253 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3254 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3255 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3256 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3257 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3258 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3260 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3261 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3266 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3267 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3268 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3269 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3270 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3271 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3272 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3276 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3277 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3278 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3279 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3280 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3281 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3282 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3283 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3284 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3286 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3287 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3288 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3290 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3291 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3292 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3293 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3295 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3296 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3297 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3299 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3300 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3301 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3302 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3303 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3305 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3306 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3310 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3311 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3312 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3313 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3314 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3315 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3316 messages to the MTA.
3319 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3320 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3321 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3322 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3323 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3324 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3325 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3329 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3330 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3331 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3332 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3333 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3334 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3335 the listening daemon.
3339 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3340 .cindex "address" "testing"
3341 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3342 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3343 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3344 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3345 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3347 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3348 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3350 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3351 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3354 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3355 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3356 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3357 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3358 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3361 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3362 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3363 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3364 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3366 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3367 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3368 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3369 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3372 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3373 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3375 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3376 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3377 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3378 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3379 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3380 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3385 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3386 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3387 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3388 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3389 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3390 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3392 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3393 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3394 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3395 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3396 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3397 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3398 dynamic testing facilities.
3402 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3403 .cindex "address" "verification"
3404 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3405 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3406 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3407 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3408 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3409 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3411 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3412 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3413 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3415 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3416 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3418 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3419 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3422 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3423 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3424 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3425 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3426 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3428 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3429 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3430 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3431 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3432 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3433 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3436 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3437 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3438 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3441 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3442 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3443 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3444 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3446 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3447 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3448 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3449 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3453 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3454 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3461 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3462 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3463 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3464 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3466 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3467 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3468 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3469 each port only when the first connection is received.
3471 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3472 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3474 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3476 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3477 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3478 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3479 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3480 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3481 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3482 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3483 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3484 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3486 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3487 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3488 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3489 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3490 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3491 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3492 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3493 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3494 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3496 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3497 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3498 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3499 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3500 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3501 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3502 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3504 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3505 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3506 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3507 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3508 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3509 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3510 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3512 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3513 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3514 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3517 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3518 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3519 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3520 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3521 specified by this option.
3524 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3526 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3527 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3528 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3529 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3530 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3531 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3533 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3534 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3535 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3536 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3537 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3538 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3539 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3541 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3542 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3543 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3549 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3550 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3553 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3555 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3556 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3559 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3561 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3562 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3563 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3564 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3565 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3566 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3567 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3570 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3571 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3572 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3573 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3574 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3575 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3576 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3579 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3580 &`auth `& authenticators
3581 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3582 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3583 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3584 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3585 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3586 &`filter `& filter handling
3587 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3588 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3589 &`ident `& ident lookup
3590 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3591 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3592 &`load `& system load checks
3593 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3594 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3595 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3596 &`memory `& memory handling
3597 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3598 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3599 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3600 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3601 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3602 &`retry `& retry handling
3603 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3604 &`route `& address routing
3605 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3607 &`transport `& transports
3608 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3609 &`verify `& address verification logic
3610 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3612 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3613 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3614 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3615 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3616 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3617 turn everything off.
3619 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3620 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3621 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3622 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3623 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3626 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3627 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3628 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3629 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3630 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3633 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3634 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3637 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3638 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3640 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3642 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3643 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3644 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3645 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3648 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3649 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3650 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3651 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3655 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3656 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3657 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3658 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3659 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3660 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3661 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3662 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3665 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3666 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3667 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3668 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3669 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3671 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3673 .cindex "sender" "name"
3674 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3675 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3676 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3677 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3678 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3679 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3681 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3683 .cindex "sender" "address"
3684 .cindex "address" "sender"
3685 .cindex "trusted users"
3686 .cindex "envelope sender"
3687 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3688 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3689 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3690 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3693 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3694 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3695 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3696 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3699 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3700 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3701 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3702 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3703 examples of shell commands:
3705 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3706 exim -f "" user@domain
3708 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3709 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3712 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3713 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3714 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3715 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3718 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3719 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3720 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3721 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3722 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3723 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3727 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3728 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3730 control = suppress_local_fixups
3732 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3733 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3736 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3739 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3741 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3742 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3743 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3748 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3749 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3750 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3751 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3752 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3753 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3755 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3757 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3758 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3759 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3760 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3761 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3762 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3764 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3766 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3768 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3769 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3770 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3771 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3772 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3773 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3774 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3777 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3778 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3779 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3780 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3781 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3782 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3784 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3785 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3786 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3787 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3789 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3791 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3792 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3793 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3794 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3795 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3796 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3797 can be used only by an admin user.
3799 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3800 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3802 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3803 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3804 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3805 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3806 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3807 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3808 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3809 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3813 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3814 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3815 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3821 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3823 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3825 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3827 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3833 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3839 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3841 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3843 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3844 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3845 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3846 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3847 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3848 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3854 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3859 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3861 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3864 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3866 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3867 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3868 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3869 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3872 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3874 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3875 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3876 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3877 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3878 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3879 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3880 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3881 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3882 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3883 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3884 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3885 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3886 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3888 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3890 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3891 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3892 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3893 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3894 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3895 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3896 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3897 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3899 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3901 .cindex "freezing messages"
3902 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3903 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3904 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3905 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3906 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3907 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3910 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3912 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3913 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3914 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3915 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3916 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3917 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3918 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3919 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3922 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3924 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3925 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3926 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3927 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3928 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3930 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3932 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3933 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3934 .cindex "removing recipients"
3935 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3936 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3937 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3938 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3939 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3940 can be used only by an admin user.
3942 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944 .cindex "removing messages"
3945 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3946 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3947 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3948 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3949 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3950 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3951 placed on the queue.
3953 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3955 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3956 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3957 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3958 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3959 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3960 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3961 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3962 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3963 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3965 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3967 .cindex "thawing messages"
3968 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3969 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3970 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3971 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3972 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3973 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3976 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3978 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3979 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3980 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3981 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3983 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3985 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3986 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3987 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3988 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3989 only by an admin user.
3991 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3993 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3994 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3995 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3996 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3997 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3999 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4001 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4002 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4003 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4004 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4008 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4009 treats it that way too.
4013 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4014 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4015 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4016 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4017 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4018 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4019 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4022 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4023 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4024 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4025 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4026 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4027 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4028 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4033 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4034 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4035 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4036 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4038 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4040 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4043 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4045 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4046 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4047 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4050 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4052 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4053 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4054 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4055 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4056 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4057 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4061 .cindex "background delivery"
4062 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4063 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4064 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4065 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4066 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4067 processes to finish.
4069 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4070 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4071 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4072 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4074 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4075 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4076 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4077 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4081 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4082 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4083 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4084 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4085 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4086 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4088 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4089 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4092 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4093 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4095 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4096 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4097 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4098 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4103 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4108 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4109 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4110 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4111 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4112 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4113 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4114 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4115 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4116 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4117 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4122 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4123 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4124 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4125 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4126 configuration file is in effect.
4128 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4129 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4130 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4131 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4132 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4133 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4134 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4135 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4136 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4141 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4142 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4143 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4146 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4148 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4149 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4150 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4151 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4155 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4156 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4157 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4158 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4159 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4163 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4164 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4165 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4166 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4167 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4171 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4172 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4177 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4178 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4183 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4184 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4185 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4186 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4187 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4188 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4191 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4192 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4194 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4196 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4197 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4198 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4199 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4200 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4201 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4203 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4204 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4206 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4208 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4209 followed by a colon and the port number:
4211 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4213 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4214 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4215 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4216 whichever one is last.
4218 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4220 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4221 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4222 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4223 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4224 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4225 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4227 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4229 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4230 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4231 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4232 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4233 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4234 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4236 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4238 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4239 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4240 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4241 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4242 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4243 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4244 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4245 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4247 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4249 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4250 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4251 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4252 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4253 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4255 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4257 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4258 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4259 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4260 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4261 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4262 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4263 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4265 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4266 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4267 is sending the bounce.
4269 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4271 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4272 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4273 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4274 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4275 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4276 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4277 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4278 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4279 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4280 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4282 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4284 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4285 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4286 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4287 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4288 uses the name it is given.
4290 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4292 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4293 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4294 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4295 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4296 used, when there is no default.
4300 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4301 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4302 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4303 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4307 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4308 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4309 whatever that means.
4311 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4313 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4314 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4315 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4316 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4317 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4318 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4319 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4321 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4323 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4324 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4325 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4326 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4327 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4329 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4331 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4332 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4333 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4334 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4335 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4336 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4340 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4342 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4344 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4345 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4346 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4347 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4348 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4349 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4350 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4351 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4355 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4356 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4357 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4358 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4363 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4364 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4365 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4366 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4369 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4371 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4373 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4375 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4376 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4377 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4378 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4379 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4380 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4384 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4385 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4386 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4387 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4388 and &%-S%& options).
4390 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4391 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4392 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4393 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4394 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4395 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4396 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4399 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4400 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4401 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4402 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4403 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4406 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4407 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4408 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4409 this to be repeated periodically.
4411 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4412 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4413 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4414 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4416 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4417 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4418 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4420 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4421 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4422 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4423 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4427 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4428 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4429 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4430 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4431 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4432 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4435 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4436 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4437 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4438 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4439 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4440 delivered down a single SMTP
4441 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4442 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4443 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4444 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4445 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4448 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4450 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4451 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4452 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4453 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4454 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4456 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4458 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4459 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4460 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4461 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4462 their retry times are tried.
4464 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4466 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4467 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4470 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4472 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4473 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4474 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4477 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4480 .cindex "named queues"
4481 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4482 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4483 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4484 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4485 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4486 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4488 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4489 will specify a queue to operate on.
4492 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4494 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4497 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4498 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4499 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4500 starting message id. For example:
4502 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4504 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4505 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4506 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4508 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4510 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4511 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4512 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4513 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4514 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4515 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4517 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4518 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4519 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4520 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4521 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4522 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4523 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4524 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4525 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4527 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4529 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4530 process every 30 minutes.
4532 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4533 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4535 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4537 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4540 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4542 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4544 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4546 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4547 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4548 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4549 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4550 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4551 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4552 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4554 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4555 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4556 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4557 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4558 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4559 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4561 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4562 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4564 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4566 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4567 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4568 applied to each queue run.
4570 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4571 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4572 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4573 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4574 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4575 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4576 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4577 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4578 address will be skipped.
4580 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4581 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4582 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4585 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4586 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4587 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4588 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4589 an arbitrary command instead.
4593 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4595 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4597 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4598 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4599 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4600 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4601 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4602 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4604 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4606 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4607 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4608 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4612 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4613 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4614 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4615 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4616 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4617 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4618 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4619 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4620 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4623 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4624 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4625 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4626 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4627 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4628 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4629 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4630 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4631 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4632 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4634 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4635 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4636 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4637 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4638 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4639 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4641 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4642 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4643 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4644 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4645 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4646 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4647 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4648 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4649 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4653 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4654 compatibility with Sendmail.
4656 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4657 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4658 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4659 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4660 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4661 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4662 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4663 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4668 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4669 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4670 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4671 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4672 set. Exim ignores this option.
4676 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4677 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4678 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4679 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4680 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4681 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4686 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4687 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4688 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4691 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4693 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4694 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4696 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4698 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4699 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4700 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4709 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4710 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4711 . creates a man page for the options.
4712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4715 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4726 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4727 "The runtime configuration file"
4729 .cindex "run time configuration"
4730 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4731 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4732 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4733 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4734 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4735 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4736 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4737 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4740 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4741 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4742 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4743 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4744 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4745 actually alter the string.
4747 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4748 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4749 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4750 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4751 existing file in the list.
4754 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4755 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4756 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4757 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4758 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4759 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4760 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4761 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4762 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4763 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4765 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4766 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4767 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4768 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4769 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4771 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4772 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4773 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4774 compromise the Exim user account.
4776 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4777 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4778 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4779 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4780 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4781 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4786 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4787 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4788 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4789 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4790 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4791 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4792 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4793 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4794 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4795 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4796 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4798 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4799 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4800 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4801 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4802 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4803 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4804 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4805 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4806 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4809 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4810 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4811 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4812 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4813 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4815 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4816 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4817 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4818 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4819 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4820 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4822 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4823 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4824 necessarily be discarded.
4825 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4826 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4827 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4828 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4829 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4830 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4832 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4833 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4834 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4835 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4836 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4837 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4838 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4840 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4841 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4842 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4846 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4847 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4848 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4849 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4850 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4851 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4852 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4853 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4856 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4859 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4860 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4861 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4863 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4864 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4865 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4867 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4868 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4869 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4871 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4872 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4873 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4874 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4877 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4878 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4879 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4881 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4882 want to use this feature, you must set
4884 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4886 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4887 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4890 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4891 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4892 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4893 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4895 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4896 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4897 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4898 and does not introduce a comment.
4900 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4901 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4902 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4903 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4904 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4906 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4907 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4908 change settings as required.
4910 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4911 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4912 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4913 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4914 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4919 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4920 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4921 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4922 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4923 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4924 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4927 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4928 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4930 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4931 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4932 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4933 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4934 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4937 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4938 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4939 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4940 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4942 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4943 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4946 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4949 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4950 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4955 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4956 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4957 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4958 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4959 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4960 definition, and must be of the form
4962 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4964 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4965 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4966 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4967 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4968 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4970 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4971 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4972 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4974 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4975 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4976 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4977 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4978 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4979 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4980 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4983 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4984 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4986 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4987 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4988 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4989 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4990 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4991 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4994 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4995 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4996 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5001 MAC == updated value
5003 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5004 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5005 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5006 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5010 MAC == MAC and something added
5012 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5013 from a number of other files.
5015 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5016 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5017 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5018 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5019 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5024 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5025 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5026 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5027 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5029 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5030 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5032 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5034 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5036 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5037 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5038 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5041 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5042 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5043 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5044 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5045 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5048 The following classes of macros are defined:
5050 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5051 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5052 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5053 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5054 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5055 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5056 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5057 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5058 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5059 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5060 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5063 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5066 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5067 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5068 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5069 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5070 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5071 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5072 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5074 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5075 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5076 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5080 message_size_limit = 50M
5082 message_size_limit = 100M
5085 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5086 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5087 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5088 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5089 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5091 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5092 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5093 in this line"& will always be true.
5095 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5096 to clarify complicated nestings.
5100 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5101 .cindex "common option syntax"
5102 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5103 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5104 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5105 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5106 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5107 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5108 space) and then the value. For example:
5110 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5112 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5113 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5114 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5115 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5116 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5117 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5118 word &"hide"&. For example:
5120 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5122 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5124 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5126 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5127 all instances of the same driver.
5129 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5130 that are found in option settings.
5133 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5134 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5135 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5136 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5137 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5138 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5139 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5140 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5141 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5142 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5143 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5144 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5149 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5154 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5159 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5160 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5161 .cindex "format" "integer"
5162 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5163 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5164 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5165 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5168 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5169 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5170 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5172 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5173 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5174 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5178 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5179 .cindex "integer format"
5180 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5181 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5182 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5183 Such options are always output in octal.
5186 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5187 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5188 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5189 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5190 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5194 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5195 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5196 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5197 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5198 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5208 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5209 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5210 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5214 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5215 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5216 .cindex "format" "string"
5217 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5218 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5219 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5220 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5221 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5222 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5223 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5224 therefore equivalent:
5226 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5227 trusted_users = uucp:\
5228 # This comment line is ignored
5231 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5232 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5233 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5234 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5235 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5238 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5239 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5240 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5242 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5243 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5247 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5248 character, that character replaces the pair.
5250 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5251 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5252 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5253 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5254 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5255 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5258 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5259 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5260 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5261 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5262 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5263 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5264 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5265 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5266 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5267 within a quoted configuration string.
5270 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5271 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5272 .cindex "format" "user name"
5273 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5274 .cindex "format" "group name"
5275 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5276 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5277 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5278 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5281 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5282 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5283 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5284 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5285 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5286 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5287 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5288 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5289 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5290 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5291 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5293 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5294 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5295 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5296 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5297 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5298 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5301 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5303 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5305 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5306 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5307 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5308 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5310 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5311 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5312 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5313 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5314 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5315 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5316 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5317 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5319 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5321 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5322 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5323 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5325 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5326 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5327 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5328 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5329 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5330 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5331 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5332 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5333 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5335 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5337 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5338 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5339 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5340 the value in quotes. For example:
5342 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5344 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5345 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5346 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5347 enclosing an empty list item.
5351 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5352 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5353 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5354 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5356 senders = user@domain :
5358 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5359 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5360 items, the second of which is empty:
5362 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5364 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5365 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5366 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5367 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5371 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5372 is at the end of the list.
5377 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5378 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5379 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5380 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5381 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5382 a sequence of lines like this:
5384 <&'instance name'&>:
5389 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5390 followed by three options settings:
5395 transport = local_delivery
5397 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5398 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5399 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5400 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5401 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5402 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5404 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5405 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5407 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5408 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5409 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5410 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5411 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5414 .cindex "generic options"
5415 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5416 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5417 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5418 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5419 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5420 .cindex "private options"
5421 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5422 they all have default values.
5424 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5425 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5426 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5428 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5429 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5430 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5431 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5432 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5433 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5434 configuration lines:
5439 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5440 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5441 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5442 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5448 command_timeout = 10s
5450 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5451 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5454 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5455 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5456 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5467 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5468 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5469 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5470 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5471 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5472 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5473 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5474 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5475 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5476 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5477 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5481 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5482 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5483 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5486 # primary_hostname =
5488 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5489 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5490 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5491 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5493 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5495 domainlist local_domains = @
5496 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5497 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5499 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5500 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5501 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5502 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5504 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5505 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5508 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5509 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5510 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5511 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5512 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5513 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5515 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5516 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5517 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5518 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5519 domain is permitted.
5521 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5522 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5523 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5524 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5525 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5526 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5528 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5529 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5530 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5532 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5534 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5535 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5537 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5538 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5539 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5540 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5541 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5542 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5543 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5544 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5545 contents of a message to be checked.
5547 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5549 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5550 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5552 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5553 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5554 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5555 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5557 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5559 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5560 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5561 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5563 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5564 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5565 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5566 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5567 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5568 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5569 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5571 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5573 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5574 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5576 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5577 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5578 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5579 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5580 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5581 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5582 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5583 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5584 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5585 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5586 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5587 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5588 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5589 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5590 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5591 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5593 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5596 # qualify_recipient =
5598 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5599 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5600 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5601 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5602 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5603 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5605 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5606 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5607 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5608 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5610 # allow_domain_literals
5612 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5613 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5614 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5615 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5616 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5617 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5619 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5623 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5624 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5625 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5626 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5627 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5628 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5629 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5630 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5632 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5633 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5638 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5639 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5640 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5641 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5642 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5643 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5646 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5647 1413 (hence their names):
5650 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5652 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5653 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5654 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5655 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5656 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5657 information, you can change this.
5659 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5660 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5665 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5666 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5667 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5668 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5670 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5671 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5673 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5674 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5676 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5679 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5680 +tls_certificate_verified
5683 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5685 # percent_hack_domains =
5687 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5688 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5689 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5691 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5692 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5693 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5694 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5695 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5696 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5697 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5698 always bounce messages.
5700 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5701 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5703 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5704 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5705 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5706 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5707 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5709 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5710 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5711 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5712 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5713 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5716 # split_spool_directory = true
5719 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5720 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5721 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5722 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5723 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5724 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5725 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5727 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5730 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5731 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5732 that are not 8-bit clean.
5734 # accept_8bitmime = false
5737 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5738 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5739 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5740 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5741 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5742 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5744 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5745 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5749 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5750 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5751 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5752 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5753 It starts with the line
5757 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5758 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5759 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5761 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5762 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5763 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5764 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5765 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5766 result of the ACL processing.
5770 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5775 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5776 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5777 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5778 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5779 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5780 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5782 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5783 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5784 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5787 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5788 domains = +local_domains
5789 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5791 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5792 domains = !+local_domains
5793 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5795 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5796 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5797 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5798 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5799 in Internet mail addresses.
5801 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5802 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5803 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5804 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5805 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5806 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5807 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5808 policy of being as safe as possible.
5810 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5811 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5812 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5813 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5814 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5815 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5817 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5818 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5819 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5820 have to modify this rule.
5822 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5823 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5824 common convention of local parts constructed as
5825 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5826 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5827 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5828 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5829 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5830 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5832 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5833 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5834 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5835 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5836 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5837 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5838 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5840 accept local_parts = postmaster
5841 domains = +local_domains
5843 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5844 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5845 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5846 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5847 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5849 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5850 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5851 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5853 require verify = sender
5855 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5856 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5857 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5858 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5859 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5860 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5861 discusses the details of address verification.
5863 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5864 control = submission
5866 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5867 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5868 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5869 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5870 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5871 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5872 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5873 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5874 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5876 accept authenticated = *
5877 control = submission
5879 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5880 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5881 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5882 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5883 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5884 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5886 require message = relay not permitted
5887 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5889 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5890 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5892 require verify = recipient
5894 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5895 fails, the address is rejected.
5897 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5898 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5900 # dnslists = black.list.example
5902 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5903 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5904 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5905 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5907 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5908 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5909 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5912 # require verify = csa
5914 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5915 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5920 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5921 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5925 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5926 of this ACL are commented out:
5929 # message = This message contains a virus \
5932 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5933 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5934 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5935 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5937 # warn spam = nobody
5938 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5939 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5940 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5941 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5943 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5944 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5945 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5946 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5947 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5948 whatever the spam score.
5952 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5955 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5956 .cindex "default" "routers"
5957 .cindex "routers" "default"
5958 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5963 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5964 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5965 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5966 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5967 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5970 # driver = ipliteral
5971 # domains = !+local_domains
5972 # transport = remote_smtp
5974 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5975 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5976 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5977 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5978 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5982 domains = ! +local_domains
5983 transport = remote_smtp
5984 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5987 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5988 domains. This is specified by the line
5990 domains = ! +local_domains
5992 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5993 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5994 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5995 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5996 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5997 passed on to the following routers.
5999 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6000 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6001 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6002 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6003 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6005 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6006 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6007 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6008 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6009 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6010 the address fails and is bounced.
6012 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6013 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6014 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6015 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6016 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6017 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6018 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6025 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6027 file_transport = address_file
6028 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6030 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6031 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6032 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6033 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6034 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6037 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6038 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6039 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6040 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6045 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6046 # local_part_suffix_optional
6047 file = $home/.forward
6052 file_transport = address_file
6053 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6054 reply_transport = address_reply
6056 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6057 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6058 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6059 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6060 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6063 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6064 # local_part_suffix_optional
6066 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6067 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6068 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6069 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6070 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6071 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6072 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6074 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6075 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6076 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6077 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6079 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6080 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6081 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6082 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6083 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6084 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6085 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6087 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6088 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6089 There are two reasons for doing this:
6092 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6093 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6096 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6097 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6098 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6099 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6103 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6104 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6105 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6106 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6108 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6109 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6110 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6112 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6114 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6120 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6121 # local_part_suffix_optional
6122 transport = local_delivery
6124 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6125 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6126 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6127 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6128 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6131 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6132 .cindex "default" "transports"
6133 .cindex "transports" "default"
6134 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6135 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6136 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6140 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6146 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6147 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6148 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6149 It is negotiated between client and server
6150 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6151 All other options are defaulted.
6155 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6162 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6163 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6164 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6165 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6166 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6167 show how this can be done.
6169 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6170 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6171 similarly-named options above.
6177 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6178 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6179 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6180 be returned to the sender.
6188 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6189 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6190 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6195 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6200 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6201 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6202 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6203 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6204 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6205 introduced by the line
6209 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6212 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6214 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6215 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6216 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6217 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6218 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6220 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6221 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6222 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6225 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6226 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6230 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6231 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6235 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6236 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6237 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6239 begin authenticators
6241 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6242 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6243 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6244 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6245 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6246 to support most MUA software.
6248 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6251 # driver = plaintext
6252 # server_set_id = $auth2
6253 # server_prompts = :
6254 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6255 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6257 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6260 # driver = plaintext
6261 # server_set_id = $auth1
6262 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6263 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6264 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6267 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6268 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6269 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6270 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6271 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6272 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6273 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6274 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6276 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6277 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6278 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6279 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6281 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6282 usercode and password are in different positions.
6283 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6285 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6289 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6290 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6292 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6294 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6296 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6297 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6298 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6299 regular expressions is discussed in
6300 online Perl manpages, in
6301 many Perl reference books, and also in
6302 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6303 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6305 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6306 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6307 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6308 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6309 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6312 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6313 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6314 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6315 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6317 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6319 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6320 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6321 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6322 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6323 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6324 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6327 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6328 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6329 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6330 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6331 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6332 match anywhere in the subject string.
6334 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6335 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6337 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6339 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6342 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6344 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6345 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6352 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6353 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6354 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6355 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6356 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6357 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6360 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6361 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6362 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6363 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6364 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6365 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6367 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6368 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6369 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6370 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6371 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6372 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6375 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6376 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6377 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6378 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6379 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6380 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6382 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6383 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6384 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6385 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6386 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6388 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6389 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6391 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6392 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6393 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6394 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6395 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6397 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6398 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6400 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6401 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6403 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6404 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6405 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6410 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6411 matches the list item.
6413 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6414 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6416 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6418 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6419 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6420 causes a second lookup to occur.
6422 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6423 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6424 lookup is permitted.
6427 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6428 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6429 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6430 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6433 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6434 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6435 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6437 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6438 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6439 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6440 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6443 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6444 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6445 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6450 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6451 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6452 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6457 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6458 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6459 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6460 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6463 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6464 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6465 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6466 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6467 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6468 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6469 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6470 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6471 be found in several places:
6473 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6474 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6475 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6477 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6478 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6479 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6480 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6482 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6483 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6484 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6485 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6486 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6487 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6488 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6490 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6491 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6492 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6493 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6494 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6495 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6496 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6498 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6499 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6501 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6502 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6503 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6504 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6505 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6506 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6507 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6509 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6510 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6511 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6513 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6514 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6515 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6516 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6517 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6518 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6519 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6520 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6521 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6522 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6524 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6525 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6526 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6527 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6528 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6529 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6530 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6531 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6532 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6534 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6535 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6536 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6537 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6538 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6539 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6540 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6542 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6543 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6544 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6545 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6547 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6548 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6549 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6550 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6551 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6553 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6554 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6555 lookup types support only literal keys.
6557 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6558 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6559 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6561 .cindex "linear search"
6562 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6563 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6564 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6565 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6566 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6567 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6568 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6569 in the file is used.
6571 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6572 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6573 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6574 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6575 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6580 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6581 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6582 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6583 wildcarding of any kind.
6585 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6586 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6587 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6588 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6589 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6590 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6591 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6592 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6593 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6596 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6597 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6598 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6599 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6600 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6601 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6602 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6603 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6606 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6607 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6608 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6609 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6610 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6611 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6612 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6613 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6614 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6616 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6617 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6618 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6619 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6621 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6622 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6625 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6627 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6628 *fish data for anythingfish
6631 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6632 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6634 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6636 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6637 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6638 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6640 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6642 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6643 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6644 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6646 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6649 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6650 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6651 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6652 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6653 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6655 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6656 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6657 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6658 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6659 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6662 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6663 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6664 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6667 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6669 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6672 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6673 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6674 be followed by optional colons.
6676 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6677 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6678 lookup types support only literal keys.
6682 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6683 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6684 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6685 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6686 many of them are given in later sections.
6689 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6690 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6691 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6692 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6693 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6695 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6696 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6697 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6699 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6700 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6701 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6702 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6703 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6704 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6705 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6707 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6708 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6709 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6710 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6712 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6713 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6714 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6715 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6717 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6718 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6719 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6720 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6722 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6723 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6724 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6725 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6726 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6727 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6728 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6729 password value. For example:
6731 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6734 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6735 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6736 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6737 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6740 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6741 .cindex lookup Redis
6742 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6743 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6746 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6747 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6748 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6749 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6752 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6753 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6755 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6756 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6757 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6758 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6759 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6760 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6761 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6762 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6763 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6765 require condition = \
6766 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6768 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6769 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6770 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6771 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6776 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6777 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6778 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6779 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6780 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6781 options such as a list of local domains.
6783 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6784 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6785 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6786 or may give up altogether.
6790 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6791 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6793 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6794 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6795 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6796 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6797 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6799 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6800 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6801 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6803 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6804 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6805 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6807 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6809 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6810 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6811 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6812 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6813 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6814 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6815 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6816 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6818 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6820 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6821 looks up these keys, in this order:
6827 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6828 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6829 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6830 Exim move on to try the next key.
6834 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6835 .cindex "partial matching"
6836 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6837 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6838 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6839 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6840 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6841 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6842 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6843 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6844 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6845 a key in a DBM file is
6847 *.dates.fict.example
6849 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6850 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6851 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6854 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6855 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6856 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6858 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6859 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6860 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6861 partial matching keys
6862 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6863 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6864 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6866 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6867 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6868 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6869 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6870 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6871 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6874 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6875 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6876 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6877 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6878 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6879 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6881 2250.dates.fict.example
6882 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6883 *.dates.fict.example
6886 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6889 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6890 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6891 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6892 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6893 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6894 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6896 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6898 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6899 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6900 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6901 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6903 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6905 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6906 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6908 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6909 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6910 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6913 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6915 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6916 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6918 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6919 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6920 for &"*"& on its own.
6922 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6926 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6927 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6928 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6929 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6930 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6931 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6932 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6934 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6935 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6936 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6937 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6938 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6943 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6944 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6945 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6946 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6947 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6948 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6949 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6951 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6952 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6953 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6954 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6955 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6956 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6958 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6959 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6965 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6966 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6967 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6968 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6969 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6970 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6974 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6975 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6977 [name="$local_part"]
6979 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6980 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6981 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6982 of the following form is provided:
6984 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6986 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6988 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6990 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6991 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6992 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6997 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6998 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6999 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7000 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7001 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7002 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7003 an expansion string could contain:
7005 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7007 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7008 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7009 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7010 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7012 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7013 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7014 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7016 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7017 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7018 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7019 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7020 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7022 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7024 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7025 white space is ignored.
7026 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7027 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7028 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7030 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7031 When the type is PTR,
7032 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7033 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7035 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7037 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7038 altered and nothing is added.
7040 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7041 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7042 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7043 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7044 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7045 The field separator can be modified as above.
7047 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7048 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7049 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7050 unless a field separator is specified.
7051 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7053 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7055 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7056 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7057 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7059 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7060 white space is ignored.
7062 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7064 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7065 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7068 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7071 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7072 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7073 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7074 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7075 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7076 each followed by a comma,
7077 that may appear before the record type.
7079 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7080 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7081 a defer-option modifier.
7082 The possible keywords are
7083 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7084 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7085 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7086 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7087 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7088 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7089 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7091 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7092 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7094 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7095 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7097 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7098 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7099 The possible keywords are
7100 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7101 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7103 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7104 is not labelled as authenticated data
7105 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7106 The default is &"never"&.
7108 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7110 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7111 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7112 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7113 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7115 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7117 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7118 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7119 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7121 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7122 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7124 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7125 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7126 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7129 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7130 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7131 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7132 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7133 the pseudo-type MXH:
7135 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7137 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7140 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7141 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7142 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7143 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7144 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7145 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7146 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7147 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7149 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7150 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7152 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7153 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7154 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7156 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7157 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7158 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7159 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7160 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7163 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7164 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7165 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7166 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7167 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7168 result of a successful lookup such as:
7170 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7172 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7173 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7174 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7176 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7177 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7178 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7179 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7181 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7185 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7186 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7187 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7188 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7189 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7191 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7192 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7193 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7195 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7196 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7197 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7198 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7200 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7201 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7202 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7207 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7208 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7209 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7210 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7211 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7212 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7213 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7214 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7215 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7216 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7217 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7218 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7220 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7221 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7222 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7223 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7224 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7226 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7227 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7229 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7230 the way they handle the results of a query:
7233 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7236 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7237 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7239 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7240 from all of them are returned.
7244 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7245 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7246 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7247 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7250 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7251 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7252 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7253 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7255 data = ${lookup ldap \
7256 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7257 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7259 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7260 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7261 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7262 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7264 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7265 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7266 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7268 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7269 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7270 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7271 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7272 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7273 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7274 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7275 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7279 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7280 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7281 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7282 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7283 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7284 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7286 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7287 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7295 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7296 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7300 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7302 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7306 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7308 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7310 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7312 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7313 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7314 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7318 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7319 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7320 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7322 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7326 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7328 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7330 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7332 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7333 authentication below.
7336 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7337 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7338 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7339 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7340 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7343 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7345 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7346 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7347 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7348 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7349 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7350 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7351 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7352 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7353 failures, and timeouts.
7355 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7356 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7357 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7358 doubled. For example
7360 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7362 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7363 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7364 the local host) is used.
7366 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7367 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7368 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7369 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7372 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7373 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7374 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7375 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7377 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7379 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7380 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7382 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7384 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7385 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7386 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7387 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7388 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7389 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7390 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7393 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7394 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7395 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7398 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7401 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7405 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7406 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7410 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7411 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7412 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7413 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7414 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7415 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7416 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7417 them. The following names are recognized:
7419 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7420 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7421 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7422 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7423 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7424 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7425 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7426 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7428 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7429 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7430 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7431 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7433 .cindex LDAP timeout
7434 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7435 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7436 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7437 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7438 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7439 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7440 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7441 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7442 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7443 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7445 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7446 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7448 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7449 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7450 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7451 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7452 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7453 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7454 alternate list (colon-separated).
7456 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7457 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7460 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7461 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7464 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7465 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7466 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7467 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7469 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7470 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7471 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7473 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7474 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7475 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7476 quoting has two advantages:
7479 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7480 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7482 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7485 For example, a setting such as
7487 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7489 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7491 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7492 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7493 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7494 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7498 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7499 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7504 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7505 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7506 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7507 as a sequence of values, for example
7509 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7511 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7512 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7513 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7514 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7515 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7518 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7519 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7520 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7521 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7523 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7524 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7525 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7526 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7527 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7528 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7529 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7530 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7531 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7533 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7534 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7535 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7536 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7537 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7540 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7543 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7546 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7547 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7549 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7550 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7552 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7553 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7556 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7557 results of LDAP lookups.
7558 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7559 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7560 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7561 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7562 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7563 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7568 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7569 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7570 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7571 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7572 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7573 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7574 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7575 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7577 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7579 might return the string
7581 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7582 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7584 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7586 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7592 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7593 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7594 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7598 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7599 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7600 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7601 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7602 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7603 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7604 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7605 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7606 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7607 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7608 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7609 .cindex lookup Redis
7610 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7612 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7615 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7618 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7619 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7621 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7626 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7628 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7629 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7630 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7634 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7635 with a newline between the data for each row.
7638 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7639 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7640 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7641 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7642 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7643 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7644 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7645 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7646 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7647 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7648 .cindex lookup Redis
7649 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7650 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7651 or &%redis_servers%&
7652 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7654 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7655 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7656 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7658 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7659 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7660 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7661 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7663 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7665 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7666 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7667 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7669 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7670 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7672 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7673 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7674 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7675 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7676 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7677 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7679 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7680 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7681 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7683 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7684 host, database number, and password.
7686 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7687 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7688 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7690 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7692 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7695 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7696 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7697 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7698 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7700 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7701 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7703 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7704 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7705 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7706 done by starting the query with
7708 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7710 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7712 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7713 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7714 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7717 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7719 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7720 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7721 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7723 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7724 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7725 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7728 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7732 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7734 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7736 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7737 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7738 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7740 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7744 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7745 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7746 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7747 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7748 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7749 the default value is &"exim"&.
7750 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7752 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7753 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7755 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7756 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7758 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7761 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7762 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7764 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7765 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7766 is zero because no rows are affected.
7769 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7770 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7771 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7772 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7773 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7776 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7778 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7779 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7780 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7782 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7783 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7786 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7787 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7788 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7789 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7790 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7791 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7792 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7793 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7794 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7796 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7797 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7799 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7801 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7802 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7804 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7805 quote, which it doubles.
7807 .cindex timeout SQLite
7808 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7809 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7810 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7811 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7812 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7813 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7814 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7817 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7818 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7819 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7820 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7823 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7824 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7831 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7832 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7834 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7835 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7836 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7837 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7838 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7839 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7840 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7841 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7842 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7844 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7845 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7846 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7847 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7849 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7850 support all the complexity available in
7851 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7855 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7856 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7857 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7859 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7860 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7863 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7864 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7865 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7866 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7867 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7870 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7871 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7872 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7874 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7875 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7876 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7877 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7878 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7880 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7881 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7883 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7884 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7885 senders based on the receiving domain.
7890 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7891 .cindex "list" "negation"
7892 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7893 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7894 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7895 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7896 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7897 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7899 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7900 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7901 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7902 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7903 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7905 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7907 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7908 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7909 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7911 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7913 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7914 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7915 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7917 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7918 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7923 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7924 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7925 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7926 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7927 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7928 file names are not allowed,
7929 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7930 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7934 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7935 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7937 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7938 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7939 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7941 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7945 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7946 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7947 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7948 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7950 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7951 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7953 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7955 and the file contains the lines
7960 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7961 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7965 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7966 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7967 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7968 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7969 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7970 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7971 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7972 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7974 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7975 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7976 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7977 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7982 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7983 .cindex "named lists"
7984 .cindex "list" "named"
7985 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7986 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7987 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7988 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7989 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7990 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7991 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7993 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7995 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7996 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7997 configured with the line
7999 domains = +local_domains
8001 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8002 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8006 domains = ! +local_domains
8007 transport = remote_smtp
8010 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8011 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8012 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8013 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8015 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8016 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8018 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8020 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8021 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8022 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8024 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8025 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8026 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8028 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8029 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8031 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8032 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8033 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8035 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8037 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8038 referenced lists if you can.
8040 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8041 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8042 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8044 domains = +local_domains
8046 on several of your routers
8047 or in several ACL statements,
8048 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8049 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8050 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8051 the same each time they are referenced.
8053 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8054 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8055 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8056 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8060 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8061 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8062 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8063 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8064 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8067 ALIST = host1 : host2
8068 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8070 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8072 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8074 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8077 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8078 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8080 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8082 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8086 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8087 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8088 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8089 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8090 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8091 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8092 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8093 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8094 message. For example:
8096 domainlist special_domains = \
8097 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8099 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8100 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8101 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8102 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8103 same list each time.
8105 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8106 cache the result anyway. For example:
8108 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8110 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8111 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8115 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8116 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8117 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8118 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8119 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8122 .cindex "primary host name"
8123 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8124 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8125 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8126 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8127 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8128 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8129 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8130 differ only in their names.
8132 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8133 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8134 .cindex "domain literal"
8135 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8136 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8137 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8138 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8139 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8140 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8143 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8144 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8145 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8146 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8147 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8148 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8149 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8150 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8151 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8152 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8153 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8155 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8156 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8157 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8158 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8159 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8161 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8162 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8163 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8164 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8165 on a router). For example:
8167 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8169 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8170 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8172 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8173 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8174 contain negative items.
8176 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8177 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8178 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8180 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8181 an.other.domain : ...
8183 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8184 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8186 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8187 an.other.domain ? ...
8190 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8191 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8192 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8193 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8194 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8195 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8196 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8197 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8198 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8202 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8203 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8204 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8205 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8206 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8207 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8208 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8209 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8210 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8212 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8213 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8214 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8215 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8216 expression by expansion, of course).
8218 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8219 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8220 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8221 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8222 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8223 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8225 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8227 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8228 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8229 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8230 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8231 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8232 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8233 other statements in the same ACL.
8236 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8237 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8239 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8241 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8242 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8245 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8246 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8247 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8248 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8249 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8250 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8253 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8254 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8255 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8256 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8258 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8259 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8261 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8262 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8263 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8264 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8265 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8267 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8268 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8269 between the pattern and the domain.
8272 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8274 domainlist funny_domains = \
8277 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8278 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8279 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8280 nis;domains.byname : \
8281 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8283 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8284 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8285 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8286 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8287 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8292 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8293 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8294 .cindex "list" "host list"
8295 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8296 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8297 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8298 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8299 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8300 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8301 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8304 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8305 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8306 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8307 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8308 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8309 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8312 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8313 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8314 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8318 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8319 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8320 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8321 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8322 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8323 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8324 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8327 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8328 inspecting its IP address:
8331 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8332 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8333 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8334 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8335 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8336 with the IP address of the subject host.
8338 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8339 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8340 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8341 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8342 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8345 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8346 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8347 domain name, as just described.
8350 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8351 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8352 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8353 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8354 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8355 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8356 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8357 that can never match a client host.
8360 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8361 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8362 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8363 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8365 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8369 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8370 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8371 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8372 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8373 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8374 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8375 significant end of the address.
8377 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8378 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8379 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8380 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8384 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8385 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8388 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8390 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8391 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8393 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8394 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8397 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8399 could make use of a file containing
8404 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8405 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8406 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8408 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8411 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8417 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8418 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8419 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8420 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8421 address, the pattern takes this form:
8423 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8427 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8429 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8430 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8431 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8432 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8433 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8434 returned by the lookup is not used.
8436 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8437 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8438 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8439 patterns of this form:
8441 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8445 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8447 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8448 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8449 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8450 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8451 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8453 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8454 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8455 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8456 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8457 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8458 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8459 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8460 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8461 addresses are always used.
8463 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8464 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8465 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8468 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8469 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8470 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8471 case the IP address is used on its own.
8475 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8476 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8477 .cindex "unknown host name"
8478 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8479 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8480 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8481 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8482 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8485 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8486 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8487 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8488 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8489 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8490 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8491 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8493 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8494 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8496 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8497 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8498 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8499 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8500 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8501 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8502 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8503 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8504 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8506 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8507 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8509 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8510 .cindex "alias for host"
8511 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8512 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8515 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8516 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8517 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8518 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8519 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8522 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8523 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8524 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8525 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8526 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8527 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8528 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8533 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8534 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8535 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8536 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8537 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8539 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8541 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8542 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8543 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8550 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8551 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8552 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8553 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8554 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8555 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8557 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8558 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8560 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8561 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8562 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8563 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8564 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8565 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8566 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8567 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8568 not recognized in an indirected file).
8571 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8572 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8574 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8576 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8577 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8580 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8581 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8584 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8587 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8588 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8589 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8592 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8593 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8596 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8598 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8600 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8601 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8602 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8605 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8606 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8607 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8609 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8611 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8612 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8613 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8614 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8615 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8616 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8617 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8620 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8621 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8623 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8624 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8626 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8627 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8628 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8633 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8635 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8636 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8637 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8638 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8639 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8640 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8641 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8642 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8643 host lists such as whitelists.
8647 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8648 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8649 .cindex "unknown host name"
8650 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8651 If a pattern is of the form
8653 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8657 dbm;/host/accept/list
8659 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8660 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8663 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8664 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8665 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8666 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8667 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8668 lookup, both using the same file.
8672 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8673 If a pattern is of the form
8675 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8677 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8678 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8679 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8681 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8682 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8684 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8685 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8686 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8689 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8690 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8691 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8693 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8694 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8695 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8696 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8697 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8698 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8704 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8705 .cindex "list" "address list"
8706 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8707 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8708 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8709 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8710 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8711 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8712 using this option setting:
8716 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8717 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8718 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8719 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8721 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8724 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8726 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8727 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8728 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8729 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8730 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8731 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8732 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8734 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8735 *@+hostile_domains:\
8736 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8737 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8739 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8740 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8741 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8742 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8743 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8745 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8746 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8747 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8748 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8749 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8751 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8754 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8755 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8759 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8760 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8761 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8762 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8763 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8764 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8765 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8767 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8768 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8770 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8771 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8774 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8775 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8776 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8779 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8780 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8781 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8783 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8784 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8785 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8786 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8788 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8789 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8791 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8792 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8793 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8794 default. For example, with this lookup:
8796 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8798 the file could contains lines like this:
8800 user1@domain1.example
8803 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8806 nimrod@jaeger.example
8810 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8811 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8813 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8815 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8816 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8818 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8819 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8820 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8824 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8825 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8830 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8831 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8832 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8833 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8834 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8835 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8836 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8837 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8838 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8840 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8841 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8842 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8843 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8844 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8847 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8849 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8851 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8853 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8855 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8856 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8857 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8858 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8859 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8860 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8862 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8865 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8868 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8869 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8870 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8871 might have entries like
8873 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8874 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8877 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8878 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8879 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8880 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8882 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8883 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8884 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8887 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8888 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8889 can only return a single list of local parts.
8892 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8893 in these two examples:
8896 senders = *@+my_list
8898 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8899 example it is a named domain list.
8904 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8905 .cindex "case of local parts"
8906 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8907 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8908 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8909 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8910 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8911 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8912 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8913 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8916 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8917 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8918 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8919 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8920 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8921 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8922 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8925 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8926 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8927 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8928 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8929 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8930 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8931 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8932 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8936 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8937 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8938 .cindex "local part" "list"
8939 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8940 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8941 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8942 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8943 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8944 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8945 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8946 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8948 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8949 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8950 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8951 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8952 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8953 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8954 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8956 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8964 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8965 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8966 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8967 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8969 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8970 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8971 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8972 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8973 escape character, as described in the following section.
8975 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8976 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8977 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8978 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8979 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8984 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8985 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8986 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8987 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8988 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8989 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8990 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8991 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8993 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8994 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8995 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8996 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8998 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9000 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9001 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9006 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9007 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9008 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9009 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9010 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9011 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9012 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9015 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9016 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9017 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9020 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9021 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9022 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9024 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9025 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9026 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9027 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9028 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9029 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9030 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9033 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9034 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9035 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9038 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9039 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9040 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9041 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9043 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9045 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9046 Exim message identifier. For example:
9048 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9050 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9051 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9054 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9055 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9056 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9057 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9058 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9059 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9060 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9061 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9062 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9063 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9064 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9065 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9071 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9072 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9073 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9074 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9075 white space is significant.
9078 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9079 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9080 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9085 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9086 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9087 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9088 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9089 given, the expansion fails.
9091 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9092 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9093 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9094 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9098 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9099 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9100 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9101 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9102 string easier to understand.
9104 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9105 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9106 expansion item below.
9109 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9110 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9111 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9112 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9113 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9114 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9115 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9116 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9117 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9118 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9119 the result of the expansion.
9120 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9121 the expansion result is an empty string.
9122 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9125 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9126 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9127 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9128 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9129 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9130 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9131 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9132 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9136 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9137 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9142 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9146 If the field is found,
9147 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9148 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9149 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9150 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9152 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9153 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9156 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9158 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9159 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9161 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9162 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9163 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9164 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9165 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9166 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9167 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9168 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9170 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9171 take an optional modifier of "int"
9172 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9173 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9174 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9176 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9177 newline-separated by default,
9178 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9179 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9180 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9182 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9183 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9184 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9185 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9186 if so the element tags are omitted.
9188 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9190 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9191 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9193 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9194 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9198 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9199 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9200 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9202 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9203 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9204 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9205 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9206 must have the following type:
9208 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9210 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9211 function should return one of the following values:
9213 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9214 into the expanded string that is being built.
9216 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9217 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9219 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9220 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9222 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9224 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9225 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9226 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9229 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9230 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9231 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9232 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9234 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9235 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9236 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9238 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9239 appear, for example:
9241 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9243 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9244 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9246 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9248 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9251 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9252 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9255 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9256 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9257 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9258 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9259 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9260 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9261 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9262 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9264 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9267 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9268 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9269 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9270 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9271 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9272 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9273 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9274 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9275 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9277 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9278 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9279 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9282 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9283 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9285 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9286 appear, for example:
9288 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9290 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9291 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9294 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9295 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9296 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9297 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9298 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9299 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9300 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9301 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9302 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9303 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9304 <&'string3'&> as before.
9306 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9307 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9308 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9309 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9310 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9311 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9312 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9313 provided. For example:
9315 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9319 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9321 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9322 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9325 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9326 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9327 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9329 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9330 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9331 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9332 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9333 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9334 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9335 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9337 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9339 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9340 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9343 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9344 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9345 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9346 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9347 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9348 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9350 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9351 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9352 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9353 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9355 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9357 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9358 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9359 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9360 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9361 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9363 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9365 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9366 letters appear. For example:
9368 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9369 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9370 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9373 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9374 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9375 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9376 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9377 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9378 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9379 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9380 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9381 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9382 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9383 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9384 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9385 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9386 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9390 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9391 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9392 lines) may be present.
9394 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9395 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9398 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9399 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9400 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9403 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9404 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9405 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9406 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9407 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9408 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9409 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9410 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9413 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9414 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9415 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9416 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9417 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9418 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9421 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9422 command of the following form:
9424 headers charset "UTF-8"
9426 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9427 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9428 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9429 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9430 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9433 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9434 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9435 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9436 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9438 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9439 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9440 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9441 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9442 router or transport are not accessible.
9444 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9445 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9446 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9447 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9448 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9449 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9450 point they are added.
9451 When any of the above ACLs ar
9452 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9454 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9455 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9456 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9457 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9458 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9459 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9460 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9463 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9464 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9465 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9466 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9467 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9468 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9469 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9470 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9473 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9474 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9476 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9477 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9478 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9479 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9480 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9481 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9482 present. For example:
9484 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9486 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9489 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9491 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9492 an Exim configuration:
9494 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9496 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9499 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9500 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9501 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9503 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9504 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9505 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9506 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9507 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9508 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9511 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9512 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9513 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9514 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9515 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9516 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9518 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9520 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9521 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9522 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9523 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9524 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9526 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9527 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9528 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9530 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9534 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9539 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9540 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9541 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9542 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9543 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9544 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9548 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9549 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9550 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9551 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9552 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9553 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9554 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9557 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9559 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9560 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9561 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9564 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9565 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9566 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9567 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9568 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9569 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9570 apart from an optional leading minus,
9571 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9573 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9574 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9576 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9577 If the number is negative, the fields are
9578 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9579 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9580 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9582 If the modulus of the
9583 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9584 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9588 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9592 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9594 yields &"result: 42"&.
9596 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9597 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9599 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9602 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9603 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9604 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9605 described in the next item.
9607 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9608 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9609 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9610 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9611 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9612 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9613 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9614 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9615 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9617 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9618 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9619 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9620 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9621 out by the system administrator.
9624 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9625 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9626 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9627 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9628 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9629 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9630 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9631 original lookup fails.
9633 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9634 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9635 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9636 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9637 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9638 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9639 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9640 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9642 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9643 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9644 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9645 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9647 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9648 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9649 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9650 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9652 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9654 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9656 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9657 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9659 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9664 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9665 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9667 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9668 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9669 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9670 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9671 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9672 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9674 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9676 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9677 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9678 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9680 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9681 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9682 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9683 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9684 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9685 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9686 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9688 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9690 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9691 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9692 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9693 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9696 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9698 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9702 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9703 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9704 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9705 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9706 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9707 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9708 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9709 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9711 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9712 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9713 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9714 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9715 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9718 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9719 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9720 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9722 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9723 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9726 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9727 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9728 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9729 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9730 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9731 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9732 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9733 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9735 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9736 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9737 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9738 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9739 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9740 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9741 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9742 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9743 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9744 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9746 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9747 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9748 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9749 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9751 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9752 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9753 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9754 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9755 is the expansion of the third argument.
9757 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9758 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9759 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9761 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9762 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9763 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9764 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9765 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9766 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9767 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9768 newlines are left in the string.
9769 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9770 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9771 the string expansion fails.
9773 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9774 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9778 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9779 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9780 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9781 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9782 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9783 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9784 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9787 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9788 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9790 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9791 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9792 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9793 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9794 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9797 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9799 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9800 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9801 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9802 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9803 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9804 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9805 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9807 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9809 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9810 and must be present if the argument is given.
9811 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9812 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9813 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9814 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9816 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9818 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9819 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9820 turns them into spaces:
9822 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9824 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9825 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9826 addition, the following errors can occur:
9829 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9831 Failure to connect the socket;
9833 Failure to write the request string;
9835 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9838 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9839 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9840 errors occurs. For example:
9842 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9845 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9846 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9847 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9848 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9849 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9851 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9852 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9855 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9856 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9857 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9860 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9861 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9862 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9863 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9864 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9865 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9866 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9867 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9868 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9870 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9872 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9875 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9877 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9878 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9881 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9882 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9883 expansion item above.
9885 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9886 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9887 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9888 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9889 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9890 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9891 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9892 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9893 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9895 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9896 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9897 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9898 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9899 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9900 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9901 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9902 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9903 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9906 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9907 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9908 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9910 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9911 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9912 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9913 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9914 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9917 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9918 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9919 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9920 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9922 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9923 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9924 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9927 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9928 log_message = Output of id: $value
9930 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9931 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9933 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9937 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9938 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9940 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9941 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9945 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9946 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9949 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9950 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9951 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9952 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9954 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9955 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9958 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9959 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9960 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9961 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9962 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9963 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9964 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9965 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9967 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9969 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9970 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9971 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9973 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9975 yields &"defabc"&, and
9977 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9979 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9980 the regular expression from string expansion.
9984 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9985 .cindex sorting "a list"
9986 .cindex list sorting
9987 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9988 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9989 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9990 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9991 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9992 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9993 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9994 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9995 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9996 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9997 to give values for comparison.
9999 The item result is a sorted list,
10000 with the original list separator,
10001 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10005 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10007 sorts a list of numbers, and
10009 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10011 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10014 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10015 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10016 .cindex "substring extraction"
10017 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10018 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10019 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10020 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10021 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10023 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10025 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10026 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10029 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10030 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10031 length required. For example
10033 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10035 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10036 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10037 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10038 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10040 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10041 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10042 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10044 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10046 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10047 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10048 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10050 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10052 yields an empty string, but
10054 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10058 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10059 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10060 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10061 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10064 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10066 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10070 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10071 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10072 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10073 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10074 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10075 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10076 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10077 replacement list. For example
10079 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10081 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10082 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10083 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10089 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10090 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10091 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10092 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10093 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10094 following operations can be performed:
10097 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10098 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10099 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10100 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10101 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10102 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10105 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10106 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10107 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10108 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10109 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10110 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10111 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10112 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10113 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10115 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10116 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10117 character. For example:
10119 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10121 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10122 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10123 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10126 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10127 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10128 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10129 email address separator. For the example header line:
10131 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10133 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10134 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10135 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10136 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10137 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10138 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10141 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10142 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10144 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10145 Last:user@example.com
10146 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10150 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10151 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10152 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10153 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10154 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10155 Only lowercase letters are used.
10157 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10158 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10159 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10160 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10161 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10163 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10164 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10165 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10166 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10167 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10168 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10169 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10170 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10171 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10173 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10174 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10175 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10176 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10177 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10178 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10181 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10182 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10183 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10184 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10185 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10186 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10188 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10189 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10192 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10193 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10194 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10195 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10196 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10199 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10200 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10201 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10202 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10203 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10206 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10207 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10208 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10209 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10210 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10211 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10212 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10214 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10215 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10216 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10217 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10218 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10219 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10222 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10223 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10224 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10225 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10226 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10227 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10228 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10229 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10230 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10231 C programming language):
10233 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10234 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10235 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10236 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10237 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10239 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10241 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10242 space is permitted before or after operators.
10244 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10245 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10246 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10247 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10248 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10250 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10252 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10253 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10256 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10257 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10258 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10259 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10260 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10261 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10262 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10263 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10264 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10265 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10266 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10269 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10271 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10274 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10277 {$recipients_count} \
10278 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10282 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10283 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10286 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10287 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10288 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10291 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10293 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10294 and then re-expands what it has found.
10297 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10299 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10300 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10301 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10302 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10303 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10304 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10305 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10306 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10307 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10309 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10310 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10311 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10312 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10313 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10314 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10315 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10318 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10319 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10320 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10321 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10322 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10323 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10325 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10327 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10328 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10332 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10333 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10334 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10335 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10336 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10337 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10341 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10342 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10343 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10344 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10345 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10346 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10347 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10350 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10351 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10352 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10353 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10354 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10355 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10356 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10358 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10359 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10360 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10361 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10362 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10363 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10364 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10365 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10366 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10369 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10370 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10371 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10372 .cindex "lower casing"
10373 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10374 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10375 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10380 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10381 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10382 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10383 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10384 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10385 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10387 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10389 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10390 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10391 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10394 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10395 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10396 .cindex "list" "item count"
10397 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10398 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10399 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10402 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10403 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10404 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10405 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10406 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10407 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10408 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10409 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10410 matching list is returned.
10413 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10414 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10415 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10416 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10417 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10421 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "masked IP address"
10423 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10424 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10425 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10426 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10427 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10428 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10429 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10430 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10431 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10433 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10435 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10436 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10437 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10438 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10440 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10444 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10446 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10449 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10451 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10452 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10453 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10454 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10455 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10457 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10458 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10461 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10462 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10463 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10464 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10465 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10466 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10468 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10470 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10473 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10474 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10475 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10476 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10477 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10478 is an empty string or
10479 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10480 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10481 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10482 respectively For example,
10490 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10491 variable or a message header.
10493 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10494 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10495 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10496 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10497 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10498 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10499 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10502 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10503 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10504 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10505 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10506 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10508 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10514 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10515 yields an unchanged string.
10518 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10519 .cindex "random number"
10520 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10521 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10522 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10523 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10524 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10525 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10526 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10527 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10531 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10532 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10533 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10534 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10535 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10536 for DNS. For example,
10538 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10539 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10544 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10548 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10549 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10550 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10551 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10552 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10553 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10554 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10555 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10556 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10559 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10561 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10562 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10566 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10567 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10568 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10569 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10570 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10571 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10572 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10573 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10575 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10576 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10577 to use this operator as well.
10581 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10583 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10584 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10585 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10586 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10587 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10590 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10591 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10592 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10593 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10594 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10595 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10596 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10598 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10599 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10602 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10603 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10604 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10605 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10606 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10607 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10609 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10611 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10612 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10615 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10616 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10617 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10618 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10619 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10620 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10622 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10624 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10625 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10626 with 256 being the default.
10628 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10629 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later.
10632 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10633 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10634 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10635 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10636 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10637 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10638 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10639 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10640 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10641 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10642 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10643 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10644 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10646 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10647 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10648 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10650 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10651 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10652 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10656 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10657 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10658 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10659 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10660 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10661 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10664 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10665 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10666 .cindex "substring extraction"
10667 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10668 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10669 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10670 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10672 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10674 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10675 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10677 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10678 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10679 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10680 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10683 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10684 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10685 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10686 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10687 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10688 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10691 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10692 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10693 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10694 .cindex "upper casing"
10695 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10696 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10697 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10699 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10701 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10702 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10703 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10704 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10705 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10707 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10708 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10709 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10710 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10711 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10712 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10714 .cindex internationalisation
10715 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10716 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10717 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10718 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10719 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10720 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10728 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10729 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10730 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10731 while expanding strings:
10734 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10735 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10736 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10737 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10740 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10741 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10742 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10743 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10749 &`>= `& greater or equal
10751 &`<= `& less or equal
10755 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10757 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10758 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10759 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10760 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10761 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10764 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10765 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10766 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10769 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10770 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10771 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10772 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10773 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10774 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10775 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10776 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10777 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10778 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10779 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10780 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10781 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10782 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10784 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10785 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10786 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10787 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10788 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10789 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10791 An empty string is treated as false.
10792 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10793 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10794 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10796 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10797 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10800 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10804 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10805 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10806 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10807 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10808 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10809 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10810 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10811 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10813 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10815 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10816 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10817 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10818 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10819 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10820 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10821 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10822 included in the binary.
10824 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10825 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10826 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10827 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10828 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10829 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10830 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10831 string in LDAP form is:
10833 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10835 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10836 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10838 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10840 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10845 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10846 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10847 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10848 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10849 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10850 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10854 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10855 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10856 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10857 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10858 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10859 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10862 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10863 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10864 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10865 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10866 whatever its length.
10869 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10870 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10871 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10872 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10874 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10875 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10876 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10877 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10878 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10879 support &[crypt16()]&.
10881 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10882 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10883 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10884 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10885 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10887 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10888 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10889 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10891 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10892 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10893 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10894 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10895 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10897 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10898 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10899 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10900 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10901 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10902 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10904 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10906 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10907 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10909 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10910 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10911 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10912 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10913 exists in the message. For example,
10915 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10917 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10918 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10920 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10921 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10922 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10923 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10924 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10925 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10926 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10927 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10928 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10930 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10931 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10932 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10933 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10934 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10935 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10936 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10937 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10939 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10940 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10941 .cindex "first delivery"
10942 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10943 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10944 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10945 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10948 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10949 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10950 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10951 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10952 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10954 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10955 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10956 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10957 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10958 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10960 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10961 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10962 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10964 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10965 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10966 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10968 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10969 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10970 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10971 list separator is changed to a comma:
10973 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10975 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10976 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10978 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10981 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10982 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10983 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10984 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10985 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10986 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10987 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10988 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10989 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10992 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10993 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10994 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10995 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10996 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10997 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10998 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10999 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11000 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11003 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11004 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11005 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11006 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11007 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11008 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11011 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11012 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11014 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11015 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11016 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11017 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11020 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11021 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11022 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11023 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11024 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11025 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11026 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11027 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11028 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11029 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11030 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11032 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11033 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11034 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11035 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11036 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11039 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11040 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11042 This is no longer the case.
11045 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11046 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11048 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11050 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11052 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11053 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11054 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11055 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11056 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11057 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11058 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11059 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11060 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11061 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11062 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11063 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11064 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11068 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11069 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11070 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11071 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11072 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11073 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11074 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11075 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11076 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11079 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11080 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11081 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11082 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11083 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11084 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11085 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11086 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11087 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11091 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11092 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11093 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11094 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11095 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11096 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11097 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11098 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11099 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11100 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11101 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11104 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11106 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11107 backslashes is also required.
11109 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11110 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11111 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11112 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11113 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11114 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11116 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11117 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11118 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11119 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11120 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11121 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11122 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11123 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11125 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11126 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11127 See &*match_local_part*&.
11129 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11130 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11131 See &*match_local_part*&.
11133 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11134 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11135 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11136 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11137 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11138 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11140 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11142 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11145 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11147 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11149 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11150 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11151 in a single test such as
11152 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11153 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11154 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11155 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11157 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11159 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11161 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11163 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11164 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11165 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11166 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11167 masks. For example:
11169 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11171 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11172 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11173 address mask, for example:
11175 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11177 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11178 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11180 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11184 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11185 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11187 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11189 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11190 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11191 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11192 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11193 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11194 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11195 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11196 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11199 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11201 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11202 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11203 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11204 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11206 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11208 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11209 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11210 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11211 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11214 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11215 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11217 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11218 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11219 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11220 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11222 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11223 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11224 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11225 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11226 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11227 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11228 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11229 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11230 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11231 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11232 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11236 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11237 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11239 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11240 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11241 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11242 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11243 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11244 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11245 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11247 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11248 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11249 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11250 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11251 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11253 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11255 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11257 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11259 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11260 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11261 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11262 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11263 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11264 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11265 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11266 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11269 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11270 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11272 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11273 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11274 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11275 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11276 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11277 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11279 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11280 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11281 building Exim. For example:
11283 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11285 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11286 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11287 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11288 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11290 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11291 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11292 configuration, you might have this:
11294 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11296 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11298 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11300 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11301 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11302 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11303 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11304 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11305 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11308 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11310 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11311 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11312 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11313 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11314 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11317 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11318 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11319 this library, you need to set
11321 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11323 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11324 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11326 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11328 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11329 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11330 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11332 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11333 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11334 the authentication is successful. For example:
11336 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11340 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11341 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11342 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11344 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11345 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11346 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11347 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11348 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11349 by a process that is not running as root.
11351 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11352 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11353 building Exim. For example:
11355 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11357 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11358 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11359 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11361 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11362 two are mandatory. For example:
11364 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11366 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11367 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11368 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11373 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11374 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11375 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11376 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11377 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11378 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11379 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11383 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11384 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11385 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11386 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11387 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11390 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11392 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11393 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11394 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11396 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11397 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11398 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11399 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11400 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11401 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11402 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11403 parsed but not evaluated.
11405 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11410 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11411 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11412 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11413 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11414 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11417 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11418 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11419 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11420 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11421 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11422 In the expansion condition case
11423 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11424 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11425 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11426 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11427 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11428 matching condition.
11430 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11431 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11432 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11433 any unused variables being made empty.
11435 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11436 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11437 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11438 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11439 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11440 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11441 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11442 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11443 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11444 during subsequent delivery.
11446 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11447 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11448 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11449 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11450 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11451 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11452 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11453 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11456 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11457 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11458 this variable has the number of arguments.
11460 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11461 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11462 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11463 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11464 be preserved by coding like this:
11466 warn !verify = sender
11467 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11469 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11470 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11473 .vitem &$address_data$&
11474 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11475 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11476 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11477 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11478 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11479 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11482 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11483 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11484 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11485 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11486 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11487 from the child's routing.
11489 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11490 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11491 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11494 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11495 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11496 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11498 .vitem &$address_file$&
11499 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11500 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11501 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11502 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11503 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11505 /home/r2d2/savemail
11507 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11508 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11509 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11510 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11511 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11512 to the relevant file.
11514 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11515 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11516 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11517 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11519 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11520 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11521 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11522 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11524 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11525 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11526 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11527 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11528 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11529 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11530 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11531 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11532 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11533 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11534 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11535 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11536 command line option.
11538 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11539 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11540 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11541 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11542 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11543 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11544 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11545 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11546 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11550 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11551 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11552 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11553 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11554 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11555 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11556 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11557 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11558 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11559 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11560 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11562 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11563 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11564 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11565 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11566 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11569 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11570 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11571 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11572 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11573 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11574 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11575 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11576 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11577 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11578 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11579 an undefined mechanism.
11581 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11582 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11583 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11584 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11585 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11586 the ACL malware condition.
11588 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11589 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11590 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11591 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11592 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11593 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11595 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11596 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11597 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11598 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11599 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11600 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11601 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11603 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11604 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11605 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11606 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11607 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11609 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11610 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11611 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11612 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11613 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11615 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11616 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11617 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11618 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11619 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11620 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11621 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11623 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11624 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11625 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11626 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11627 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11628 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11629 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11631 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11632 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11633 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11634 address that was connected to.
11636 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11637 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11638 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11639 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11640 compilations of the same version of the program.
11642 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11643 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11644 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11645 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11646 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11647 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11649 .vitem &$config_file$&
11650 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11651 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11653 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11654 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11655 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11656 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11657 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11658 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11660 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11661 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11662 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11663 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11664 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11665 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11666 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11667 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11668 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11669 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11670 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11671 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11672 &$dkim_key_length$&
11673 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11674 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11676 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11677 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11678 When a message has been received this variable contains
11679 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11680 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11682 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11683 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11684 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11686 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11687 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11688 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11689 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11690 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11691 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11692 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11693 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11694 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11697 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11698 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11699 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11700 case for &$domain$&.
11702 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11703 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11704 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11705 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11707 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11708 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11709 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11710 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11711 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11712 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11714 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11715 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11716 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11718 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11721 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11722 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11723 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11724 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11725 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11726 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11727 the &(smtp)& transport.
11730 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11731 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11732 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11733 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11736 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11737 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11738 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11739 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11740 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11741 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11744 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11745 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11746 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11747 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11751 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11752 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11753 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11754 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11755 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11756 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11757 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11760 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11761 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11762 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11765 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11766 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11767 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11769 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11770 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11771 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11773 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11774 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11775 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11777 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11778 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11779 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11780 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11781 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11782 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11784 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11785 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11786 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11787 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11788 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11790 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11791 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11792 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11793 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11794 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11798 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11799 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11800 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11801 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11802 by a setting on the transport itself.
11804 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11805 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11806 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11810 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11811 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11812 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11813 to local and remote transports.
11815 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11816 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11817 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11818 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11819 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11820 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11821 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11824 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11825 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11826 client is connected.
11829 .vitem &$host_address$&
11830 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11831 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11832 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11833 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11835 .vitem &$host_data$&
11836 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11837 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11838 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11839 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11841 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11842 message = $host_data
11844 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11845 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11846 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11847 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11848 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11849 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11850 variables is set to &"1"&.
11853 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11854 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11857 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11858 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11859 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11862 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11863 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11864 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11865 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11866 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11867 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11868 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11869 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11870 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11871 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11873 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11874 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11875 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11877 .vitem &$host_port$&
11878 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11879 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11880 for an outbound connection.
11882 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11883 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11884 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11885 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11886 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11887 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11890 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11891 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11892 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11893 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11894 a unique name for the file.
11896 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11897 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11898 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11900 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11901 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11902 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11906 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11907 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11908 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11912 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11913 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11914 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11917 .vitem &$load_average$&
11918 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11919 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11920 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11921 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11923 .vitem &$local_part$&
11924 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11925 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11926 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11927 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11928 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11930 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11931 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11932 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11933 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11936 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11937 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11938 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11939 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11940 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11941 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11943 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11944 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11945 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11948 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11949 local part of the recipient address.
11951 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11952 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11953 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11955 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11958 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11959 abc\:xyz@test.example
11961 the value of &$local_part$& is
11965 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11966 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11969 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11971 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11972 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11973 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11975 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11976 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11977 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11978 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11979 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11980 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11981 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11983 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11984 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11985 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11986 variable expands to nothing.
11988 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11989 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11990 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11991 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11992 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11994 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11995 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11996 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11997 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11998 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12000 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12001 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12002 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12003 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12005 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12006 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12007 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12009 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12010 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12011 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12012 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12013 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12014 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12015 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12016 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12018 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12019 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12020 This contains the expanded value of the
12021 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12024 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12025 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12026 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12027 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12028 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12029 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12031 .vitem &$log_space$&
12032 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12033 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12034 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12035 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12036 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12037 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12040 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12041 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12042 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12043 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12044 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12045 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12046 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12047 and &"yes"& if it was.
12048 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12049 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12050 as authenticated data.
12052 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12053 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12054 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12055 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12056 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12057 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12058 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12061 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12062 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12063 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12064 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12065 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12067 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12068 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12069 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12070 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12071 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12072 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12075 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12078 .vitem &$message_age$&
12079 .cindex "message" "age of"
12080 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12081 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12082 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12085 .vitem &$message_body$&
12086 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12087 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12088 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12089 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12090 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12091 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12092 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12093 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12094 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12096 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12097 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12098 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12099 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12100 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12102 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12103 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12104 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12105 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12106 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12107 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12110 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12111 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12112 .cindex "message body" "size"
12113 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12114 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12115 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12116 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12117 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12120 If the spool file is wireformat
12121 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12122 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12125 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12126 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12127 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12128 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12129 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12130 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12131 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12132 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12134 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12135 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12136 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12137 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12138 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12139 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12141 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12142 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12143 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12144 contents of header lines is done.
12146 .vitem &$message_id$&
12147 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12149 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12150 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12151 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12152 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12153 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12154 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12155 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12156 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12157 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12158 from the body is not counted.
12160 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12161 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12162 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12163 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12164 header and the body).
12166 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12168 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12170 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12172 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12173 message has not yet been received.
12176 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12179 .vitem &$message_size$&
12180 .cindex "size" "of message"
12181 .cindex "message" "size"
12182 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12183 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12184 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12185 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12186 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12187 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12188 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12189 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12190 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12192 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12193 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12194 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12195 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12197 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12198 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12199 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12200 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12202 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12203 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12204 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12206 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12207 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12208 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12209 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12210 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12211 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12212 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12213 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12214 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12215 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12217 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12218 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12219 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12221 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12222 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12223 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12224 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12225 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12226 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12227 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12228 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12229 the original address.
12231 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12232 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12233 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12234 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12235 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12237 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12238 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12239 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12241 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12242 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12243 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12244 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12245 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12246 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12247 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12248 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12249 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12251 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12252 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12253 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12254 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12255 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12256 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12257 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12258 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12261 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12262 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12263 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12264 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12266 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12267 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12268 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12269 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12272 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12274 This variable contains the current process id.
12276 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12277 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12278 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12279 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12280 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12281 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12282 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12283 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12284 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12285 variable"& error if encountered.
12287 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12288 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12289 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12290 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12291 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12292 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12293 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12296 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12297 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12298 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12299 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12301 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12303 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12305 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12306 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12307 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12308 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12310 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12311 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12312 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12313 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12315 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12316 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12317 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12318 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12320 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12321 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12322 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12323 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12325 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12326 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12327 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12329 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12330 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12331 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12332 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12334 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12335 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12336 .cindex "named queues"
12337 .cindex queues named
12338 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12340 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12341 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12342 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12343 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12344 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12346 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12347 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12348 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12349 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12350 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12351 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12353 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12354 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12355 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12356 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12357 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12359 .vitem &$received_count$&
12360 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12361 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12362 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12363 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12366 .vitem &$received_for$&
12367 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12368 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12369 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12370 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12371 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12373 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12374 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12375 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12376 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12377 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12378 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12379 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12382 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12383 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12384 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12385 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12386 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12388 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12390 .vitem &$received_port$&
12391 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12392 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12394 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12395 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12396 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12397 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12398 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12399 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12400 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12401 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12402 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12404 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12405 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12406 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12407 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12408 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12409 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12411 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12412 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12413 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12415 .vitem &$received_time$&
12416 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12417 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12418 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12420 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12421 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12422 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12423 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12424 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12426 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12427 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12429 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12430 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12431 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12432 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12434 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12435 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12436 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12437 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12440 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12441 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12444 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12447 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12448 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12452 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12455 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12458 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12459 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12461 .vitem &$recipients$&
12462 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12463 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12464 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12465 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12466 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12470 In a system filter file.
12472 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12473 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12474 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12475 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12477 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12481 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12482 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12483 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12484 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12485 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12486 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12489 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12490 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12491 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12492 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12494 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12495 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12496 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12497 these variables contain the
12498 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12501 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12502 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12503 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12504 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12505 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12506 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12507 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12509 .vitem &$return_path$&
12510 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12511 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12512 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12513 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12514 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12515 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12516 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12517 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12518 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12519 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12522 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12523 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12524 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12526 .vitem &$router_name$&
12527 .cindex "router" "name"
12528 .cindex "name" "of router"
12529 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12530 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12533 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12534 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12535 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12536 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12537 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12538 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12539 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12542 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12543 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12544 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12545 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12546 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12547 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12548 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12549 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12551 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12552 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12553 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12554 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12555 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12556 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12558 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12559 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12560 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12561 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12562 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12563 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12564 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12565 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12567 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12568 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12569 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12571 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12572 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12573 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12575 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12576 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12577 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12578 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12579 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12582 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12583 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12585 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12586 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12587 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12588 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12590 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12591 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12592 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12593 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12594 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12595 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12596 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12597 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12598 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12599 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12600 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12601 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12602 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12604 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12605 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12606 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12607 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12608 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12610 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12611 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12612 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12613 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12614 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12615 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12617 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12618 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12619 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12620 this variable contains that
12621 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12623 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12624 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12625 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12626 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12627 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12628 &$authenticated_id$&.
12630 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12631 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12632 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12633 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12634 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12635 resolver library states that both
12636 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12637 other times, this variable is false.
12639 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12640 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12641 library, by setting:
12646 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12647 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12649 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12650 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12652 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12653 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12654 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12655 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12658 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12659 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12660 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12661 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12662 other means, this variable is empty.
12664 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12665 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12666 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12667 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12668 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12669 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12670 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12672 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12673 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12674 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12675 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12677 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12678 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12679 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12682 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12683 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12684 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12685 following are true:
12688 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12690 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12691 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12692 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12694 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12695 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12696 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12698 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12699 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12700 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12702 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12703 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12704 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12705 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12707 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12709 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12710 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12714 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12715 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12716 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12717 number that was used on the remote host.
12719 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12720 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12721 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12722 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12723 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12726 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12727 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12728 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12729 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12731 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12732 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12733 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12734 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12735 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12736 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12737 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12738 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12739 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12740 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12741 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12744 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12745 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12746 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12747 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12748 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12750 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12751 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12752 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12753 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12754 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12756 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12757 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12758 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12759 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12760 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12761 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12762 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12764 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12765 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12766 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12767 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12768 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12770 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12771 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12772 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12773 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12774 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12775 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12777 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12778 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12779 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12780 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12781 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12786 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12787 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12788 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12789 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12791 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12792 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12793 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12794 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12795 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12796 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12797 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12800 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12801 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12802 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12803 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12804 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12808 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12809 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12810 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12811 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12812 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12813 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12814 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12815 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12816 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12817 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12818 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12820 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12821 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12822 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12823 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12824 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12825 message is junk mail.
12827 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12828 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12829 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12830 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12833 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12834 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12835 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12837 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12838 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12839 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12840 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12841 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12842 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12844 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12845 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12846 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12847 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12848 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12849 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12850 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12851 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12853 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12855 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12858 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12859 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12860 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12861 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12862 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12863 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12865 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12866 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12867 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12868 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12869 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12870 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12871 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12872 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12874 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12875 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12878 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12879 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12880 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12881 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12882 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12883 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12885 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12886 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12887 .cindex certificate variables
12888 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12889 inbound connection when the message was received.
12890 It is only useful as the argument of a
12891 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12892 or a &%def%& condition.
12894 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12895 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12896 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12897 inbound connection when the message was received.
12898 It is only useful as the argument of a
12899 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12900 or a &%def%& condition.
12901 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12902 which is not the leaf.
12904 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12905 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12906 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12907 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12908 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12909 or a &%def%& condition.
12911 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12912 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12913 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12914 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12915 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12916 or a &%def%& condition.
12917 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12918 which is not the leaf.
12920 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12921 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12922 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12923 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12925 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12926 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12929 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12930 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12931 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12932 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12933 and &"0"& otherwise.
12935 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12936 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12937 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12938 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12939 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12940 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12941 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12942 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12943 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12945 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12946 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12947 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12949 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12950 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12952 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12953 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12954 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12955 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12957 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12958 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12959 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12960 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12962 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12963 1 No response to request
12964 2 Response not verified
12965 3 Verification failed
12966 4 Verification succeeded
12969 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12970 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12971 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12972 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12973 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12975 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12976 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12977 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12978 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12979 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12980 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12981 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12982 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12983 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12984 which is not the leaf.
12986 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12987 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12990 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12991 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12992 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12993 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12994 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12995 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12996 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12997 which is not the leaf.
12999 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13000 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13001 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13002 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13003 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13004 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13005 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13006 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13007 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13008 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13009 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13011 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13012 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13015 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13016 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13017 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13019 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13022 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13023 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13024 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13025 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13027 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13028 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13029 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13031 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13032 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13033 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13035 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13036 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13037 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13038 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13039 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13040 values for those that are behind (west).
13043 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13044 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13045 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13047 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13048 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13049 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13050 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13053 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13054 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13055 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13058 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13059 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13060 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13061 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13063 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13064 .cindex "transport" "name"
13065 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13066 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13067 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13070 .vindex "&$value$&"
13071 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13072 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13073 &*reduce*& expansion.
13075 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13076 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13077 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13078 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13081 .vitem &$version_number$&
13082 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13083 The version number of Exim.
13085 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13086 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13087 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13088 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13090 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13091 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13092 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13093 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13099 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13102 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13103 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13104 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13105 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13106 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13107 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13112 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13115 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13116 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13117 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13118 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13119 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13120 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13121 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13122 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13123 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13125 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13126 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13127 should usually be something like
13129 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13131 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13132 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13133 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13134 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13135 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13136 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13137 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13138 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13142 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13143 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13144 a startup when Exim is entered.
13146 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13147 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13150 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13151 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13154 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13155 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13156 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13157 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13158 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13159 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13163 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13164 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13165 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13166 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13170 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13171 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13173 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13174 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13175 with an error message of the form
13177 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13179 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13180 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13181 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13182 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13183 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13184 that was passed to &%die%&.
13187 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13188 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13189 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13192 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13194 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13195 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13196 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13198 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13199 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13200 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13201 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13203 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13204 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13205 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13206 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13207 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13208 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13209 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13212 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13213 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13214 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13215 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13216 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13217 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13218 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13219 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13220 avoided, but the output is lost.
13222 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13223 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13224 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13225 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13226 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13227 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13228 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13230 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13232 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13233 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13234 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13235 as the first subroutine argument.
13239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13240 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13242 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13243 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13244 "Starting the daemon"
13245 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13246 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13247 .cindex "network interface"
13248 .cindex "interface" "network"
13249 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13250 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13251 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13252 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13253 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13254 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13255 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13256 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13257 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13258 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13259 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13262 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13263 and ports to listen on.
13265 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13266 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13267 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13268 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13269 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13270 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13271 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13272 as an error situation.
13274 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13275 for the outgoing connection.
13279 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13280 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13281 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13282 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13283 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13285 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13286 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13287 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13288 chapter describes how they operate.
13290 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13291 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13295 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13296 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13297 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13301 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13303 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13305 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13306 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13309 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13310 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13311 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13312 colons. For example:
13314 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13317 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13319 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13320 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13323 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13324 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13326 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13327 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13330 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13331 with a colon separator, for example:
13333 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13334 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13338 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13339 default setting contains just one port:
13341 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13343 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13344 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13345 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13346 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13347 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13351 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13352 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13353 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13354 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13355 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13356 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13358 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13360 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13362 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13364 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13368 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13369 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13370 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13371 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13372 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13373 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13376 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13377 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13378 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13379 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13380 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13381 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13385 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13388 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13390 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13391 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13392 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13396 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13397 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13398 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13399 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13400 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13401 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13402 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13403 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13404 list of port numbers or service names,
13405 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13406 common use of this option is expected to be
13408 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13410 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13411 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13412 this way when a daemon is started.
13414 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13415 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13416 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13417 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13418 connections via the daemon.)
13423 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13424 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13425 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13426 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13427 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13428 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13429 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13430 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13432 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13434 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13435 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13436 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13437 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13438 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13439 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13441 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13443 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13444 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13445 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13446 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13447 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13449 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13450 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13451 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13452 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13453 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13454 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13455 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13456 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13457 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13458 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13459 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13460 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13462 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13463 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13464 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13465 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13466 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13470 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13471 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13473 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13474 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13476 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13477 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13478 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13479 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13481 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13483 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13485 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13487 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13488 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13490 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13491 IPv4 loopback address only:
13493 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13495 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13497 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13499 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13503 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13504 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13505 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13506 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13509 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13510 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13511 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13512 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13514 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13515 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13516 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13517 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13518 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13519 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13520 used for listening. Consider this example:
13522 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13524 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13526 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13528 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13529 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13532 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13533 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13534 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13535 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13536 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13537 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13538 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13539 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13543 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13544 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13545 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13546 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13547 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13548 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13557 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13558 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13559 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13560 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13563 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13564 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13566 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13567 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13568 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13570 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13571 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13572 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13573 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13577 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13578 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13579 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13580 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13581 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13582 listed in more than one group.
13584 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13586 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13587 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13588 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13589 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13590 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13591 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13592 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13593 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13594 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13595 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13596 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13600 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13602 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13603 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13604 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13605 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13606 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13607 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13612 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13614 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13615 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13616 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13617 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13618 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13619 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13620 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13621 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13622 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13623 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13624 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13625 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13630 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13632 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13633 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13634 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13635 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13636 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13637 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13638 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13639 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13640 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13641 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13642 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13643 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13644 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13645 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13646 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13651 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13653 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13654 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13655 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13656 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13661 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13663 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13664 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13665 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13666 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13667 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13668 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13669 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13670 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13671 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13672 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13673 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13674 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13675 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13676 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13677 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13682 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13684 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13685 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13690 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13692 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13693 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13694 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13699 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13701 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13702 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13703 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13704 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13705 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13706 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13707 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13712 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13714 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13715 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13716 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13717 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13718 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13719 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13720 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13721 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13722 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13723 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13724 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13725 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13726 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13727 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13728 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13729 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13731 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13732 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13733 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13734 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13735 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13740 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13742 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13743 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13744 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13745 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13746 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13747 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13748 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13749 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13750 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13751 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13752 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13753 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13754 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13755 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13756 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13757 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13758 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13759 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13760 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13761 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13762 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13763 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13765 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13766 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13767 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13768 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13769 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13770 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13771 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13772 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13773 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13774 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13775 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13776 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13777 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13778 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13779 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13780 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13781 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13782 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13783 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13788 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13790 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13792 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13794 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13795 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13796 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13801 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13803 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13804 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13805 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13806 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13807 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13808 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13809 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13810 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13811 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13812 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13813 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13814 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13815 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13816 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13817 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13818 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13819 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13824 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13826 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13827 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13828 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13829 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13830 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13831 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13832 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13833 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13838 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13840 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13841 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13842 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13843 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13844 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13845 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13846 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13847 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13853 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13855 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13862 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13863 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13866 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13867 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13868 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13869 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13870 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13871 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13872 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13873 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13874 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13875 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13876 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13877 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13878 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13879 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13880 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13882 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13883 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13884 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13885 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13886 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13887 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13888 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13889 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13890 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13891 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13892 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13893 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13894 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13895 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13896 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13897 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13902 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13904 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13905 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13906 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13907 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13908 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13909 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13910 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13911 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13912 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13913 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13918 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13920 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13921 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13922 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13923 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13925 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13926 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13927 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13928 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13929 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13930 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13931 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13932 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13933 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13934 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13939 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13941 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13942 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13944 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13945 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13946 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13947 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13948 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13953 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13955 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13956 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13957 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13958 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13959 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13960 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13961 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13962 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13963 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13964 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13965 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13966 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13967 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13968 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13969 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13970 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13971 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13972 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13973 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13974 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13975 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13976 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13977 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13978 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13983 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13985 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13986 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13987 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13988 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13989 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13990 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13991 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13992 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13993 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13994 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13995 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13996 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13997 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13998 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13999 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14004 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14005 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14008 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14010 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14011 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14012 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14013 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14014 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14015 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14016 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14018 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14019 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14020 It now defaults to true.
14021 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14023 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14026 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14028 log_selector = +8bitmime
14031 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14032 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14033 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14034 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14035 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14038 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14039 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14040 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14043 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14044 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14045 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14046 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14047 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14049 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14050 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14051 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14052 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14053 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14055 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14056 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14057 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14058 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14060 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14061 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14062 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14063 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14064 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14066 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14067 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14068 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14069 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14070 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14071 This option defines the ACL that,
14072 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14073 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14074 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14075 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14077 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14078 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14079 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14080 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14081 of a received message.
14082 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
14084 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14085 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14086 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14087 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14089 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14090 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14091 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14092 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14094 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14095 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14096 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14097 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14098 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14101 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14102 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14103 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14104 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14106 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14107 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14108 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14109 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14110 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14112 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14113 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14114 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14115 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14116 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14118 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14119 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14120 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14121 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14122 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14124 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14125 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14126 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14129 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14130 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14131 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14132 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14134 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14135 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14136 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14137 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14139 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14140 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14141 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14142 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14144 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14145 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14146 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14147 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14149 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14150 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14151 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14152 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14153 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14155 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14156 .cindex "admin user"
14157 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14158 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14159 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14160 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14161 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14162 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14163 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14165 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14166 .cindex "domain literal"
14167 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14168 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14169 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14170 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14172 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14173 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14174 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14175 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14176 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14177 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14178 the local host's IP addresses.
14181 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14182 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14183 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14184 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14185 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14186 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14187 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14188 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14189 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14191 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14192 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14193 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14194 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14195 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14196 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14197 experiment if they wish.
14199 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14200 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14201 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14202 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14203 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14204 suitable setting is:
14206 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14207 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14209 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14211 dns_check_names_pattern =
14213 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14216 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14217 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14218 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14219 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14220 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14221 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14222 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14223 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14224 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14225 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14226 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14228 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14229 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14230 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14231 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14232 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14233 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14235 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14236 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14237 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14238 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14240 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14242 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14243 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14244 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14245 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14248 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14249 .cindex "thawing messages"
14250 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14251 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14252 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14253 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14254 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14255 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14257 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14258 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14259 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14262 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14263 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14264 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14266 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14268 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14269 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14272 .option bi_command main string unset
14274 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14275 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14276 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14277 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14280 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14281 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14282 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14283 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14284 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14285 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14288 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14289 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14290 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14291 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14293 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14294 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14295 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14296 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14297 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14298 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14299 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14300 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14301 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14302 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14304 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14305 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14306 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14307 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14308 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14309 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14310 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14311 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14312 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14313 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14315 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14316 during reception of a message.
14317 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14319 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14322 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14323 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14324 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14325 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14328 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14329 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14330 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14331 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14332 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14333 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14334 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14335 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14336 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14338 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14339 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14340 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14341 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14342 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14345 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14346 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14347 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14348 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14349 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14350 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14351 connection. A typical setting might be:
14353 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14355 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14357 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14359 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14362 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14363 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14364 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14365 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14366 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14367 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14370 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14371 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14372 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14373 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14376 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14377 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14378 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14379 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14382 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14383 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14384 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14385 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14388 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14389 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14390 callout verification. The default value is
14392 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14394 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14397 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14398 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14401 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14402 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14404 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14405 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14406 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14407 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14408 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14409 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14410 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14411 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14412 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14413 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14416 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14417 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14420 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14421 .cindex "checking disk space"
14422 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14423 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14424 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14425 message is accepted.
14427 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14428 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14429 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14430 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14431 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14432 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14433 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14434 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14437 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14438 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14440 check_spool_space = 100M
14441 check_spool_inodes = 100
14443 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14444 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14447 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14448 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14449 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14451 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14452 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14453 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14454 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14455 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14456 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14458 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14459 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14460 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14462 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14463 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14464 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14466 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14467 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14468 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14469 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14471 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14472 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14473 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14474 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14476 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14479 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14480 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14481 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14482 administrative user.
14483 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14486 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14487 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14488 .cindex memory debugging
14489 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14490 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14491 it should normally be left as default.
14493 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14494 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14495 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14496 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14497 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14498 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14500 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14501 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14502 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14503 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14504 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14505 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14506 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14508 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14509 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14511 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14512 .cindex "warning of delay"
14513 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14514 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14515 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14516 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14517 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14518 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14519 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14520 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14523 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14525 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14526 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14527 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14528 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14532 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14533 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14535 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14537 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14538 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14539 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14541 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14542 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14543 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14544 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14545 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14546 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14547 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14548 not sent. The default is:
14550 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14551 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14552 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14553 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14556 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14557 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14558 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14559 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14561 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14562 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14563 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14564 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14565 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14566 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14567 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14568 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14570 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14571 .cindex "load average"
14572 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14573 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14574 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14575 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14576 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14579 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14580 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14581 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14582 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14583 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14584 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14585 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14586 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14588 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14589 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14590 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14591 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14592 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14593 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14594 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14595 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14597 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14598 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14599 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14600 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14603 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14604 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14605 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14606 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14607 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14608 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14609 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14612 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14613 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14614 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14615 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14616 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14617 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14620 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14621 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14622 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14623 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14624 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14625 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14626 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14627 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14628 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14629 by a setting such as this:
14631 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14633 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14634 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14635 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14636 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14637 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14638 options are applied after this global option.
14640 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14641 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14642 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14643 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14644 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14645 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14646 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14647 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14648 value of this option. The default pattern is
14650 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14651 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14653 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14654 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14655 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14656 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14657 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14660 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14661 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14662 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14664 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14665 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14666 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14667 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14670 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14671 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14672 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14673 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14674 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14675 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14677 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14680 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14681 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14682 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14683 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14684 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14685 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14686 domain matches this list.
14688 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14689 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14690 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14693 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14694 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14695 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14696 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14697 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14698 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14699 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14700 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14701 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14702 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14703 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14704 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14706 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14709 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14710 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14713 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14714 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14715 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14716 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14717 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14718 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14719 match with this expanded domain list.
14721 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14722 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14723 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14724 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14725 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14726 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14728 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14729 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14730 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14732 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14733 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14734 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14735 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14736 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14738 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14739 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14740 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14741 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14742 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14743 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14744 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14745 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14748 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14750 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14751 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14752 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14755 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14756 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14757 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14758 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14760 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14761 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14762 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14763 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14764 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14765 and accepted from, these hosts.
14766 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14767 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14768 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14769 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14772 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14773 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14774 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14775 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14776 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14777 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14779 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14781 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14782 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14784 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14785 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14786 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14787 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14788 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14789 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14790 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14791 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14792 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14795 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14796 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14797 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14798 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14799 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14800 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14801 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14802 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14803 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14805 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14806 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14807 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14808 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14809 are examined. For example:
14811 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14812 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14813 postmaster@mydomain.example
14815 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14816 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14817 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14818 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14819 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14820 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14821 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14824 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14825 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14826 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14828 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14830 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14831 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14832 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14833 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14834 overrides the default.
14836 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14837 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14838 and warning messages. For example:
14840 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14842 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14843 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14844 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14845 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14849 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14851 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14852 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14855 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14856 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14857 .cindex "Exim group"
14858 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14859 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14860 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14861 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14862 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14866 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14867 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14868 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14869 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14870 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14871 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14873 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14874 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14875 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14876 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14879 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14880 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14881 .cindex "Exim user"
14882 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14883 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14884 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14885 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14887 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14888 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14889 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14890 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14893 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14894 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14895 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14896 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14899 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14900 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14902 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14903 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14905 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14906 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14907 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14908 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14909 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14910 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14911 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14912 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14913 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14914 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14918 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14919 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14920 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14921 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14922 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14923 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14924 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14925 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14928 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14929 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14930 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14931 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14935 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14936 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14937 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14938 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14939 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14940 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14941 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14942 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14943 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14944 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14945 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14946 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14947 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14948 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14949 logging that you require.
14952 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14954 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14955 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14956 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14957 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14958 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14959 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14960 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14961 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14963 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14964 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14965 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14968 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14969 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14970 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14971 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14973 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14977 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14978 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14981 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14982 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14983 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14984 implementations of TLS.
14987 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14988 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14989 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14992 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14997 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14998 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14999 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15000 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15001 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15002 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15006 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15007 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15008 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15009 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15010 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15011 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15012 sections are rejected.
15015 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15016 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15017 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15018 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15019 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15020 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15021 zero means &"no limit"&.
15026 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15027 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15028 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15029 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15030 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15031 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15032 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15033 if you want to do semantic checking.
15034 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15038 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15039 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15040 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15041 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15042 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15043 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15044 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15046 helo_allow_chars = _
15048 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15051 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15052 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15053 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15054 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15055 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15056 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15057 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15061 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15062 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15063 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15064 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15065 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15066 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15067 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15068 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15069 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15070 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15071 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15072 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15074 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15075 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15076 EHLO command either:
15079 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15081 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15082 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15083 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15084 calling host address, or
15086 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15089 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15090 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15091 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15093 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15094 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15095 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15097 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15098 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15099 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15100 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15101 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15102 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15103 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15104 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15105 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15108 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15109 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15110 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15111 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15112 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15113 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15114 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15115 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15116 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15118 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15119 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15120 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15121 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15122 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15124 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15125 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15126 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15127 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15130 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15131 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15132 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15133 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15134 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15135 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15136 default configuration file contains
15140 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15141 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15143 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15144 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15145 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15147 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15148 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15149 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15150 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15151 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15152 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15155 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15156 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15157 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15158 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15159 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15162 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15163 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15164 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15165 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15169 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15170 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15171 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15172 as soon as the connection is made.
15173 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15174 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15175 connections immediately.
15177 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15178 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15179 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15180 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15181 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15184 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15185 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15186 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15187 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15188 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15189 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15190 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15191 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15192 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15194 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15196 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15200 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15201 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15202 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15203 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15206 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15207 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15208 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15209 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15210 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15212 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15213 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15215 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15216 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15217 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15218 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15219 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15220 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15221 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15224 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15225 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15226 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15227 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15228 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15232 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15233 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15234 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15235 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15236 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15237 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15239 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15240 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15241 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15242 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15243 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15244 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15245 for frozen messages. For example,
15247 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15249 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15250 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15251 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15252 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15253 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15254 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15257 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15258 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15259 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15260 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15261 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15262 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15263 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15264 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15265 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15266 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15269 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15270 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15272 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15273 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15274 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15275 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15276 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15277 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15278 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15279 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15280 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15282 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15283 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15285 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15286 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15287 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15288 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15290 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15291 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15292 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15295 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15296 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15297 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15301 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15302 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15303 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15304 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15308 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15309 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15310 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15311 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15312 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15313 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15314 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15315 and constrained to be a directory.
15318 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15319 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15320 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15321 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15322 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15323 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15324 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15325 and constrained to be a file.
15328 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15329 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15330 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15331 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15332 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15333 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15336 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15337 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15338 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15339 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15340 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15341 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15342 identity to be proven.
15345 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15346 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15347 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15348 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15349 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15352 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15353 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15354 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15355 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15356 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15360 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15361 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15362 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15363 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15364 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15365 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15369 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15370 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15371 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15372 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15373 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15375 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15376 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15377 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15380 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15381 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15382 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15383 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15384 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15385 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15386 has been built with LDAP support.
15390 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15391 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15392 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15393 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15394 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15395 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15396 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15398 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15399 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15400 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15402 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15403 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15404 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15405 and the default qualify domain.
15407 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15408 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15409 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15410 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15412 .cindex "envelope sender"
15413 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15414 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15415 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15417 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15418 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15419 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15424 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15425 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15426 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15427 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15428 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15429 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15430 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15433 local_from_prefix = *-
15435 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15437 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15439 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15440 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15444 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15445 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15448 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15449 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15450 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15451 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15452 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15453 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15454 &%local_interfaces%& is
15456 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15458 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15460 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15463 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15464 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15465 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15466 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15467 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15468 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15469 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15470 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15474 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15475 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15476 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15477 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15478 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15479 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15480 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15481 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15486 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15487 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15488 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15489 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15490 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15491 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15492 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15493 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15494 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15495 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15496 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15497 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15498 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15499 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15500 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15504 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15505 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15506 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15507 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15508 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15509 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15510 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15511 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15512 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15513 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15514 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15515 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15516 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15517 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15518 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15521 .option log_selector main string unset
15522 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15523 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15524 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15525 minus characters. For example:
15527 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15529 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15530 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15533 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15534 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15535 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15536 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15537 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15538 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15539 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15540 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15541 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15542 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15543 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15544 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15545 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15548 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15549 .cindex "too many open files"
15550 .cindex "open files, too many"
15551 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15552 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15553 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15554 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15555 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15556 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15557 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15558 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15559 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15560 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15561 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15562 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15565 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15566 .cindex "length of login name"
15567 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15568 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15569 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15570 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15571 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15572 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15575 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15576 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15577 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15578 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15579 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15580 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15581 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15582 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15585 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15586 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15587 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15588 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15589 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15590 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15591 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15594 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15595 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15596 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15597 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15598 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15599 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15600 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15601 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15602 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15603 empty string, the option is ignored.
15606 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15607 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15608 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15609 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15610 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15611 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15612 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15613 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15614 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15615 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15616 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15617 colons will become hyphens.
15620 .option message_logs main boolean true
15621 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15622 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15623 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15624 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15625 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15626 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15627 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15628 which is not affected by this option.
15631 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15632 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15633 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15634 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15635 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15636 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15637 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15638 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15639 optionally followed by K or M.
15641 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15642 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15643 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15644 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15645 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15647 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15648 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15649 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15650 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15651 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15652 message that an individual transport can process.
15654 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15655 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15656 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15657 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15658 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15659 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15660 some problems may result.
15662 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15663 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15664 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15667 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15668 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15669 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15671 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15673 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15674 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15675 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15676 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15677 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15680 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15681 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15682 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15683 contains a full description of this facility.
15687 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15688 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15689 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15690 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15691 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15694 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15695 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15696 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15697 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15698 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15701 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15702 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15703 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15704 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15705 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15707 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15708 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15711 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15713 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15714 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15718 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15719 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15720 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15721 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15722 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15724 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15725 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15726 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15727 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15728 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15729 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15730 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15732 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15733 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15734 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15735 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15736 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15738 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15740 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15741 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15742 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15743 some now infamous attacks.
15747 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15748 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15749 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15751 # Disable older protocol versions:
15752 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15755 Possible options may include:
15759 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15761 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15763 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15767 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15769 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15771 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15773 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15775 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15777 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15781 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15795 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15799 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15801 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15803 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15805 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15809 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15812 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15813 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15814 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15815 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15816 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15817 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15820 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15821 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15822 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15823 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15824 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15827 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15828 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15829 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15830 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15831 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15832 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15833 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15834 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15835 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15836 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15839 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15840 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15841 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15842 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15843 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15844 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15845 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15848 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15850 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15851 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15854 .option perl_startup main string unset
15856 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15857 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15859 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15861 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15864 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15865 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15866 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15867 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15868 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15869 PostgreSQL support.
15872 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15873 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15874 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15875 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15876 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15879 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15881 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15883 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15884 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15885 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15888 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15889 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15890 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15891 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15892 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15893 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15894 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15895 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15896 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15899 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15900 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15901 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15902 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15903 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15904 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15905 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15906 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15908 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15909 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15910 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15911 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15912 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15913 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15914 volume of mail. Use with care!
15917 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15918 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15919 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15920 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15921 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15922 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15923 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15924 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15925 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15926 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15928 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15929 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15930 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15931 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15932 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15933 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15936 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15937 .cindex "printing characters"
15938 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15939 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15940 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15941 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15942 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15943 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15946 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15947 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15948 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15949 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15950 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15954 .option process_log_path main string unset
15955 .cindex "process log path"
15956 .cindex "log" "process log"
15957 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15958 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15959 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15960 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15961 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15962 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15963 different spool directories.
15966 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15967 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15971 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15972 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15973 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
15976 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15977 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15978 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15979 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15980 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15981 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15982 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15983 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15984 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15986 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15987 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15988 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15989 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15990 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15991 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15992 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15995 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15996 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15997 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16001 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16002 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16003 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16004 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16005 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16006 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16007 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16008 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16011 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16012 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16014 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16015 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16016 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16017 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16020 .option queue_only main boolean false
16021 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16022 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16023 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16024 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16025 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16026 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16028 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16029 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16030 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16031 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16034 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16035 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16036 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16037 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16038 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16039 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16040 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16041 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16042 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16044 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16046 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16047 &_/some/file_& exists.
16050 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16051 .cindex "load average"
16052 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16053 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16054 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16055 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16056 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16057 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16058 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16061 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16062 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16063 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16064 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16067 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16068 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16069 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16070 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16071 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16072 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16073 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16074 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16075 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16076 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16077 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16078 re-evaluated for each message.
16081 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16082 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16083 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16084 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16085 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16086 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16089 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16090 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16091 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16092 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16093 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16094 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16095 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16096 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16097 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16098 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16099 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16100 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16101 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16105 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16106 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16107 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16108 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16109 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16110 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16111 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16112 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16113 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16115 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16116 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16117 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16118 the daemon's command line.
16120 .cindex queues named
16121 .cindex "named queues"
16122 To set limits for different named queues use
16123 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16125 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16126 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16127 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16128 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16129 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16130 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16131 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16132 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16133 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16134 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16135 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16136 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16137 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16141 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16142 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16143 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16144 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16145 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16146 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16147 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16149 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16150 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16151 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16152 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16153 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16154 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16155 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16156 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16157 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16158 header lines. The default setting is:
16161 received_header_text = Received: \
16162 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16163 {${if def:sender_ident \
16164 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16165 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16166 by $primary_hostname \
16167 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16168 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16169 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16170 ${if def:sender_address \
16171 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16172 id $message_exim_id\
16173 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16176 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16177 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16178 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16179 header lines such as the following:
16181 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16182 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16183 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16184 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16185 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16186 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16187 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16189 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16190 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16191 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16192 message was accepted.
16195 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16196 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16197 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16198 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16199 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16200 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16201 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16202 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16205 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16206 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16207 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16208 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16209 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16210 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16211 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16212 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16213 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16214 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16215 option was not set.
16218 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16219 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16220 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16221 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16222 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16223 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16224 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16225 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16228 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16229 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16230 RCPT commands in a single message.
16233 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16234 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16235 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16236 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16237 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16238 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16239 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16242 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16243 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16244 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16245 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16246 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16247 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16248 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16249 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16250 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16251 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16252 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16253 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16254 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16255 tagged with its process id.
16257 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16258 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16259 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16260 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16263 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16264 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16265 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16266 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16267 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16268 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16269 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16270 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16271 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16272 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16273 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16275 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16276 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16277 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16278 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16281 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16282 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16283 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16284 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16285 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16287 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16289 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16290 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16293 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16294 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16295 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16296 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16297 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16301 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16302 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16303 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16304 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16305 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16306 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16307 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16311 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16312 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16313 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16314 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16315 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16316 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16317 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16318 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16319 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16320 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16323 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16324 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16327 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16329 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16330 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16331 an item in the list.
16332 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16335 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16336 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16337 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16338 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16339 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16342 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16343 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16344 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16345 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16346 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16347 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16348 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16349 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16350 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16351 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16353 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16354 .cindex "environment"
16355 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16356 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16357 default list is empty,
16360 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16361 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16362 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16363 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16364 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16365 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16366 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16370 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16371 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16372 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16373 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16374 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16375 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16376 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16377 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16378 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16379 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16380 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16384 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16385 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16386 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16388 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16389 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16390 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16391 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16392 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16393 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16395 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16396 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16397 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16398 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16401 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16402 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16403 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16404 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16405 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16406 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16407 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16408 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16410 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16411 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16412 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16413 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16414 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16415 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16416 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16417 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16420 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16421 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16422 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16423 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16427 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16428 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16429 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16430 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16431 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16432 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16433 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16434 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16435 . the option name to split.
16437 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16438 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16439 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16440 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16441 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16442 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16443 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16444 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16445 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16449 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16450 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16451 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16452 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16453 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16454 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16455 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16456 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16457 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16458 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16459 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16461 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16462 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16463 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16464 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16465 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16466 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16470 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16471 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16472 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16473 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16474 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16475 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16476 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16477 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16478 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16479 to all messages received in the same connection.
16481 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16482 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16483 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16484 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16487 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16489 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16490 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16491 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16492 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16493 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16494 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16495 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16496 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16497 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16498 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16499 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16500 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16501 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16504 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16505 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16506 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16507 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16508 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16509 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16510 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16511 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16512 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16513 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16514 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16517 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16518 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16519 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16520 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16523 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16524 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16525 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16526 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16527 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16528 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16529 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16530 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16531 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16533 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16534 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16535 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16536 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16538 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16539 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16540 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16541 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16542 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16545 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16546 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16549 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16550 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16551 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16552 &%helo_data%& value.
16554 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16555 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16556 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16557 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16558 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16559 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16560 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16562 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16563 $version_number $tod_full
16565 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16566 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16567 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16568 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16569 multiline response).
16572 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16573 .cindex "checking disk space"
16574 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16575 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16576 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16577 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16578 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16579 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16580 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16583 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16584 .cindex "connection backlog"
16585 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16586 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16587 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16588 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16589 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16590 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16591 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16592 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16593 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16594 attacks by SYN flooding.
16597 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16598 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16599 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16600 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16601 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16602 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16603 fewer, but they still exist.
16605 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16606 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16607 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16608 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16609 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16610 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16611 does detect many instances.
16613 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16614 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16615 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16616 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16620 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16621 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16622 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16623 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16624 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16625 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16626 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16627 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16630 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16631 $sender_host_address
16633 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16634 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16635 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16636 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16637 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16641 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16642 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16643 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16644 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16645 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16648 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16649 .cindex "load average"
16650 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16651 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16652 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16653 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16654 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16655 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16659 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16660 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16661 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16662 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16663 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16665 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16667 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16668 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16669 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16670 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16671 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16673 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16674 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16675 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16676 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16677 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16678 not count towards the limit.
16682 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16683 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16684 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16685 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16686 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16689 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16690 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16694 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16695 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16696 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16697 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16698 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16699 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16702 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16703 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16704 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16705 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16707 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16708 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16709 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16710 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16714 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16716 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16717 fractional parts are allowed here.
16719 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16721 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16722 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16725 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16726 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16728 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16729 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16731 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16732 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16733 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16734 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16737 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16738 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16741 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16742 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16745 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16746 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16747 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16748 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16749 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16750 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16751 the message is abandoned.
16752 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16754 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16755 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16757 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16758 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16760 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16761 expanded before use and may depend on
16762 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16766 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16767 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16768 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16769 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16770 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16773 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16774 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16775 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16778 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16779 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16780 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16781 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16782 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16783 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16784 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16785 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16786 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16787 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16789 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16790 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16794 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16795 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16796 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16797 the availability thereof is advertised in
16798 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16799 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16802 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16803 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16804 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16805 The default value is
16809 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16813 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16814 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16815 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16816 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16817 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16818 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16819 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16820 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16821 arrival of the message.
16823 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16824 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16825 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16826 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16827 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16829 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16830 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16831 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16832 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16833 automatically deleted.
16835 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16836 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16837 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16838 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16839 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16840 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16841 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16842 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16843 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16846 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16847 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16848 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16849 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16850 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16851 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16852 &$primary_hostname$&.
16854 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16855 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16856 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16857 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16858 as failures in the configuration file.
16860 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16861 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16864 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16865 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16866 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16867 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16868 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16869 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16872 The following variables will not have useful values:
16874 $max_received_linelength
16879 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16880 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16881 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16882 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16884 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16885 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is contructed for them).
16886 The transimssion benefit is maintained.
16889 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16890 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16891 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16892 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16894 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16895 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16896 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16897 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16898 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16899 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16901 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16902 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16903 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16904 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16905 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16906 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16907 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16910 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16911 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16912 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16913 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16914 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16915 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16916 domain causes a syntax error.
16917 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16921 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16922 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16923 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16924 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16925 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16926 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16927 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16928 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16929 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16930 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16931 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16932 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16935 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16936 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16937 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16938 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16939 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16940 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16941 details of Exim's logging.
16944 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
16945 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
16946 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
16947 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
16948 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
16949 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
16950 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16954 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16955 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16956 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16957 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16958 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16962 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16963 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16964 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16965 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16966 details of Exim's logging.
16969 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16970 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16971 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16972 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16973 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16974 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16975 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16976 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16977 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16978 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16979 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16980 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
16983 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16984 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16985 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16986 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16987 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16988 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16991 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16992 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16993 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16994 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16995 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16997 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16998 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16999 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17000 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17001 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17003 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17004 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17005 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17006 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17007 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17008 contains the pipe command.
17011 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17012 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17013 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17014 is used in a system filter.
17017 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17018 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17019 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17020 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17021 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17022 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17023 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17024 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17025 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17026 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17028 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17029 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17030 transport option overrides.
17033 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17034 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17035 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17036 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17037 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17038 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17039 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17040 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17041 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17042 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17043 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17044 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17048 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17049 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17050 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17051 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17052 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17053 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17054 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17055 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17056 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17057 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17059 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17060 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17061 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17064 .option timezone main string unset
17065 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17066 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17067 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17068 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17069 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17070 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17074 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17075 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17076 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17077 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17078 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17079 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17082 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17083 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17084 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17085 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17086 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17087 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17088 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17089 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17090 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17091 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17092 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17095 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
17096 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17097 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17098 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17099 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
17100 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17101 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17103 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17104 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17105 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17106 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17108 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17109 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17110 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17111 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17113 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17114 generated for every connection.
17116 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17117 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17118 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17119 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17120 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
17122 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17125 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17126 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17127 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17128 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17129 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17130 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17132 The value must be at least 1024.
17134 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17135 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17136 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17138 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17141 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17142 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17143 larger prime than requested.
17146 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17147 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17148 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17149 to be used by Exim.
17151 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17152 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17153 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17154 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17156 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17157 then it names a file from which DH
17158 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17159 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17160 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17161 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17162 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17163 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17165 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17168 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17169 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17170 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17171 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17173 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17174 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17176 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17177 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17178 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17180 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17181 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17182 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17183 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17184 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17186 The available standard primes are:
17187 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17188 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17189 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17190 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17192 The available additional primes are:
17193 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17195 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17196 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17197 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17198 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17199 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17201 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17202 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17203 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17205 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17206 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17207 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17208 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17209 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17212 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17213 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17214 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17215 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17216 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17217 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17218 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17221 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17222 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17223 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17224 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17226 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17227 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17228 for valid selections.
17230 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17231 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17232 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17234 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17237 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17238 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17239 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17241 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17242 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17243 Certificate Authority.
17245 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17248 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17251 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17252 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17253 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17254 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17258 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
17259 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17260 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17261 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
17262 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17263 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17264 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17266 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17269 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17270 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17271 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17272 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17273 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17274 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17278 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17279 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17280 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17281 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17282 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17283 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17284 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17285 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17286 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17287 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17288 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17291 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17292 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17293 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17294 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17297 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17298 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17299 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17300 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17302 or the absolute path to
17303 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17304 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17306 The "system" value for the option will use a
17307 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17308 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17309 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17312 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17313 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17315 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17317 either by file or directory
17318 are added to those given by the system default location.
17320 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17321 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17322 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17323 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17324 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17325 use the explicit directory version.
17327 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17329 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17333 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17334 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17335 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17336 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17337 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17338 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17339 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17340 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17342 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17343 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17344 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17345 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17346 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17347 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17348 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17350 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17351 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17352 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17353 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17354 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17355 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17356 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17359 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17363 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17364 .cindex "trusted groups"
17365 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17366 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17367 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17368 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17369 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17370 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17371 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17374 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17375 .cindex "trusted users"
17376 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17377 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17378 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17379 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17380 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17381 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17382 Exim user are trusted.
17384 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17385 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17386 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17387 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17388 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17389 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17390 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17391 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17392 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17395 .option unknown_username main string unset
17396 See &%unknown_login%&.
17398 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17399 .cindex "trusted users"
17400 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17401 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17402 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17403 .cindex "envelope sender"
17404 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17405 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17406 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17407 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17408 is used) is ignored.
17410 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17411 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17413 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17415 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17416 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17417 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17418 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17419 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17420 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17421 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17422 followed by a hyphen
17423 by a setting like this:
17425 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17427 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17428 restriction, you can use
17430 untrusted_set_sender = *
17432 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17433 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17434 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17435 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17436 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17437 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17438 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17439 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17441 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17442 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17443 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17444 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17448 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17449 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17450 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17451 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17452 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17453 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17454 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17455 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17456 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17457 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17459 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17460 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17462 The pattern can be seen by running
17464 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17466 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17467 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17468 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17469 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17470 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17471 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17474 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17475 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17478 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17479 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17480 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17481 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17482 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17483 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17484 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17485 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17488 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17489 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17490 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17491 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17492 .ecindex IIDconfima
17493 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17498 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17499 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17501 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17502 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17503 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17504 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17505 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17507 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17508 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17509 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17510 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17511 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17515 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17516 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17517 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17518 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17519 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17520 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17521 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17523 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17524 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17525 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17526 routers, and the eventual transport.
17528 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17529 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17530 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17531 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17532 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17534 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17535 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17536 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17537 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17538 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17540 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17541 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17542 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17544 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17546 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17548 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17550 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17551 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17553 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17554 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17555 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17556 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17557 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17558 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17559 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17563 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17565 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17566 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17567 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17568 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17569 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17574 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17575 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17576 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17577 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17578 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17579 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17580 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17581 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17582 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17583 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17586 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17588 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17591 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17593 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17594 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17595 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17596 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17599 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17600 .cindex "case of local parts"
17601 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17602 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17603 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17604 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17605 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17606 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17607 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17610 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17611 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17612 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17613 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17614 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17615 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17616 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17617 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17618 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17620 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17621 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17622 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17623 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17627 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17628 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17629 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17630 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17632 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17633 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17634 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17635 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17636 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17637 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17638 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17639 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17640 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17641 the router is skipped.
17643 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17644 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17645 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17646 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17647 setting to achieve this. For example:
17649 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17651 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17652 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17653 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17657 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17658 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17659 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17660 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17661 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17662 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17663 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17664 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17666 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17667 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17669 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17670 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17672 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17673 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17674 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17676 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17678 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17680 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17683 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17685 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17686 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17690 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17691 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17692 be specified using &%condition%&.
17694 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17695 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17696 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17697 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17698 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17699 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17700 Router rules processing behavior.
17702 This is best illustrated in an example:
17704 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17705 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17707 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17710 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17713 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17714 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17715 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17716 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17717 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17718 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17719 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17720 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17722 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17723 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17724 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17725 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17728 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17729 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17730 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17731 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17732 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17735 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17736 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17737 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17738 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17739 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17740 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17741 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17742 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17743 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17744 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17745 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17746 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17747 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17748 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17752 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17753 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17754 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17755 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17756 transport option of the same name.
17758 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17759 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17760 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17761 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17762 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17763 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17764 the dnssec request bit set.
17765 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17767 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17768 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17769 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17770 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17771 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17772 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17773 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17774 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17775 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17778 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17779 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17780 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17781 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17782 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17783 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17784 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17785 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17789 .option driver routers string unset
17790 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17794 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17795 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17796 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17797 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17798 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17799 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17800 Not effective on redirect routers.
17804 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17805 .cindex "envelope sender"
17806 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17807 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17808 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17809 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17810 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17811 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17812 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17814 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17815 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17816 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17819 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17820 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17821 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17822 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17824 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17825 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17826 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17827 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17833 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17834 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17835 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17836 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17837 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17839 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17840 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17841 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17842 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17843 setting &%return_path%&.
17845 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17846 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17847 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17851 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17852 .cindex "address" "testing"
17853 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17854 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17855 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17856 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17857 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17858 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17859 on for the system alias file.
17860 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17863 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17864 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17865 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17869 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17870 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17871 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17872 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17876 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17877 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17878 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17882 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17883 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17884 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17888 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17889 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17890 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17891 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17892 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17893 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17894 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17895 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17896 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17898 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17899 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17900 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17901 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17902 transport for further details.
17905 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17906 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17907 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17908 .cindex "transport" "local"
17909 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17910 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17911 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17913 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17914 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17915 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17916 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17917 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17921 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17922 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17923 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17924 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17925 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17926 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17927 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17928 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17929 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17930 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17931 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17932 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17933 &"see"& the added header lines.
17935 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17936 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17937 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17938 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17940 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17941 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17943 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17944 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17946 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17947 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17948 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17949 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17950 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17951 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17952 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17953 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17954 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17955 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17959 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17960 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17961 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17962 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17963 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17964 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17965 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17966 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17967 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17968 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17969 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17970 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17971 &"see"& the original header lines.
17973 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17974 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17975 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17978 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17979 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17981 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17982 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17984 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17985 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17986 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17987 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17989 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17990 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17991 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17995 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17996 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17997 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17998 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17999 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18000 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18001 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18004 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18008 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18010 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18011 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18012 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18013 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18014 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18015 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18017 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18018 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18020 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18021 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18023 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18024 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18026 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18027 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18028 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18029 domain that is being routed.
18031 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18032 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18035 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18036 .cindex "additional groups"
18037 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18038 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18039 .cindex "transport" "local"
18040 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18041 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18042 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18043 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18044 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18048 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18049 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18050 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18051 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18052 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18053 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18056 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18057 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18058 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18059 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18060 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18061 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18062 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18063 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18064 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18066 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18067 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18068 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18069 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18070 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18071 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18072 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18073 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18074 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18075 the relevant transport.
18077 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18078 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18079 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18082 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18083 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18084 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18085 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18086 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18090 local_part_prefix = real-
18092 transport = local_delivery
18094 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18095 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18097 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18098 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18101 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18102 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18103 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18104 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18107 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18108 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18112 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18113 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18114 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18115 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18116 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18117 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18118 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18119 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18120 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18124 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18125 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18129 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18130 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18131 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18132 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18133 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18135 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18136 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18139 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18141 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18142 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18143 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18144 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18145 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18146 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18147 each virtual domain:
18151 local_parts = postmaster
18152 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18156 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18157 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18158 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18159 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18160 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18161 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18162 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18163 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18164 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18165 redirect addresses.
18169 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18170 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18171 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18172 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18173 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18174 delivery to be deferred.
18176 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18177 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18179 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18180 means of the setting
18184 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18185 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18186 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18188 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18189 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18190 controls what happens next.
18193 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18194 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18195 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18196 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18197 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18198 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18199 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18200 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18202 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18203 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18204 applies to all of them.
18208 .option pass_router routers string unset
18209 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18210 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18211 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18212 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18213 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18214 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18215 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18216 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18217 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18218 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18222 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18223 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18224 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18225 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18226 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18227 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18229 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18230 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18231 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18232 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18236 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18237 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18238 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18239 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18240 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18241 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18242 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18244 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18245 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18246 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18247 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18249 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18250 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18251 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18252 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18253 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18256 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18257 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18260 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18261 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18262 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18263 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18264 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18265 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18266 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18267 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18269 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18270 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18271 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18272 operates as follows:
18274 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18275 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18276 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18277 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18280 require_files = mail:/some/file
18281 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18283 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18284 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18286 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18287 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18288 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18289 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18291 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18292 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18293 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18294 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18295 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18297 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18298 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18299 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18300 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18301 check again in that process.
18303 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18304 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18305 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18306 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18307 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18308 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18309 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18311 require_files = +/some/file
18313 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18314 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18315 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18319 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18320 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18321 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18322 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18323 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18324 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18325 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18326 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18329 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18330 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18331 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18332 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18333 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18336 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18337 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18338 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18342 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18343 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18344 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18346 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18347 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18348 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18349 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18350 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18351 cause the router to defer.
18353 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18354 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18356 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18358 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18359 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18361 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18362 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18363 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18364 of these values that is set:
18367 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18369 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18371 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18373 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18376 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18377 router, but not for the transport.
18381 .option self routers string freeze
18382 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18383 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18384 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18385 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18386 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18387 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18389 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18390 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18391 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18392 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18393 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18395 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18396 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18397 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18398 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18399 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18404 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18406 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18407 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18408 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18409 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18411 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18412 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18413 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18418 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18419 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18420 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18421 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18422 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18423 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18429 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18430 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18431 be passed to the next router.
18434 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18437 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18438 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18439 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18440 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18441 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18442 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18447 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18448 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18449 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18450 address matches something on the list.
18451 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18454 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18455 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18456 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18457 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18458 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18459 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18460 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18464 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18465 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18466 .cindex "packet radio"
18467 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18468 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18469 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18470 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18471 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18472 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18473 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18474 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18476 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18477 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18478 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18479 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18480 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18481 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18482 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18483 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18484 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18485 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18487 translate_ip_address = \
18488 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18491 The file would contain lines like
18493 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18494 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18496 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18501 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18502 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18503 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18504 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18505 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18506 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18507 delivery is deferred.
18509 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18510 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18511 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18515 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18516 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18517 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18518 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18519 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18520 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18521 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18522 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18523 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18524 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18525 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18531 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18532 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18533 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18534 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18535 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18536 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18537 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18538 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18539 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18540 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18542 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18543 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18544 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18545 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18546 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18548 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18554 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18555 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18556 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18557 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18558 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18559 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18560 delivery to be deferred.
18562 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18563 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18564 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18565 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18566 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18567 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18569 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18570 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18571 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18572 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18573 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18574 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18575 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18576 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18578 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18579 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18580 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18581 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18582 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18583 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18584 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18585 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18586 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18587 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18589 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18590 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18591 subsequent routers.
18594 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18595 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18596 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18597 .cindex "transport" "local"
18598 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18599 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18600 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18601 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18602 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18603 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18604 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18605 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18606 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18607 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18608 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18609 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18613 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18614 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18615 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18618 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18619 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18621 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18622 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18623 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18624 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18625 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18626 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18627 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18629 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18630 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18631 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18635 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18636 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18638 delivering in cutthrough mode
18639 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18640 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18642 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18645 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18646 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18647 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18648 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18650 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18651 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18652 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18662 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18663 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18664 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18665 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18666 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18667 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18668 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18669 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18670 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18674 domains = mydomain.example
18676 transport = local_delivery
18678 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18679 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18680 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18681 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18691 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18692 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18693 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18694 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18695 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18696 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18698 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18699 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18700 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18701 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18704 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18705 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18706 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18707 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18708 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18709 generic option, the router declines.
18711 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18712 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18713 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18715 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18716 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18717 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18718 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18719 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18720 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18723 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18724 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18725 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18726 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18727 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18728 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18730 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18731 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18732 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18733 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18734 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18735 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18736 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18737 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18738 case routing fails.
18741 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18742 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18743 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18744 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18745 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18747 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18748 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18750 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18752 The domain does not exist in DNS
18754 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18755 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18756 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18758 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18760 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18762 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18763 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18765 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18766 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18768 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18769 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18771 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18772 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18778 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18779 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18780 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18782 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18783 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18784 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18785 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18786 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18787 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18788 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18791 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18792 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18793 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18794 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18795 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18796 required. For example,
18800 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18801 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18802 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18803 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18804 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18807 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18808 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18809 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18810 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18811 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18812 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18814 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18815 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18816 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18817 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18818 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18819 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18820 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18821 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18823 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18824 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18829 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18830 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18831 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18832 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18833 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18834 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18835 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18836 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18840 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18841 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18842 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18843 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18844 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18845 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18846 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18849 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18851 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18852 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18853 the address record.
18856 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18857 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18858 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18859 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18864 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18865 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18866 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18867 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18868 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18869 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18870 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18871 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18872 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18877 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18878 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18879 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18880 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18881 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18882 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18883 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18884 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18885 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18886 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18887 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18889 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18890 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18893 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18894 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18895 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18896 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18897 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18901 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18902 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18903 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18904 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18905 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18906 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18907 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18908 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18910 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18911 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18912 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18913 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18914 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18915 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18916 without processing them independently,
18917 provided the following conditions are met:
18920 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18921 &%headers_remove%&.
18923 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18930 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18931 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18932 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18933 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18934 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18935 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18936 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18937 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18938 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18939 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18941 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18942 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18947 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18948 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18949 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18950 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18955 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18956 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18957 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18958 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18961 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18963 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18964 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18965 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18966 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18967 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18968 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18971 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18972 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18973 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18974 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18975 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18977 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18978 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18979 such as that implied by
18983 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18984 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18985 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18986 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18999 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19000 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19001 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19002 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19003 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19004 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19005 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19006 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19007 router handles the address
19011 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19012 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19013 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19015 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19017 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19018 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19020 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19021 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19022 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19023 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19025 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19026 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19027 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19028 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19035 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19036 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19037 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19038 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19039 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19040 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19043 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19045 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19047 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19048 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19049 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19050 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19051 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19052 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19053 must not be specified for it.
19055 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19056 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19057 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19058 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19059 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19060 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19061 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19064 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19065 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19066 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19067 delivery to the address is deferred.
19070 .option port iplookup integer 0
19071 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19072 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19076 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19077 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19078 protocols is to be used.
19081 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19082 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19085 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19087 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19088 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19091 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19092 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19093 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19094 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19095 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19096 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19097 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19098 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19101 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19102 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19103 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19104 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19105 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19106 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19107 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19108 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19109 following could be used:
19111 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19112 reroute = $local_part@$1
19115 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19116 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19117 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19118 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19126 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19127 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19128 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19129 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19130 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19131 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19132 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19133 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19134 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19135 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19137 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19138 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19139 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19140 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19141 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19142 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19143 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19146 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19147 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19148 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19149 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19150 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19151 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19152 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19155 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19156 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19157 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19158 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19159 below, following the list of private options.
19162 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19164 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19165 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19167 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19168 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19170 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19171 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19172 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19173 of the following values:
19182 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19183 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19184 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19187 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19188 router only if &%more%& is true.
19190 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19191 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19192 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19193 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19195 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19196 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19197 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19200 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19201 .cindex "randomized host list"
19202 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19203 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19204 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19205 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19206 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19207 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19208 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19209 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19211 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19212 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19213 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19214 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19216 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19218 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19219 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19220 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19221 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19222 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19225 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19226 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19227 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19230 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19232 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19233 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19237 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19238 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19239 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19240 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19243 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19244 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19245 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19246 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19247 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19248 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19249 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19250 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19252 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19253 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19254 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19255 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19256 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19257 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19258 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19259 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19264 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19265 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19266 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19267 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19268 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19269 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19271 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19273 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19277 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19278 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19280 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19281 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19282 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19283 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19284 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19285 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19286 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19287 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19288 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19289 in a &%route_list%&).
19291 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19292 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19293 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19294 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19298 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19299 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19300 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19301 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19302 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19303 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19304 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19307 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19308 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19310 This data can be accessed by setting
19312 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19314 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19315 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19316 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19317 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19318 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19323 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19324 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19325 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19326 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19327 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19328 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19329 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19331 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19332 variables are set during its expansion:
19335 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19336 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19337 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19339 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19342 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19344 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19347 .vindex "&$value$&"
19348 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19349 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19351 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19355 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19356 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19360 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19361 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19362 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19363 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19364 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19365 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19368 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19369 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19370 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19372 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19373 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19376 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19377 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19378 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19379 number follows. For example:
19381 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19385 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19386 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19387 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19388 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19389 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19392 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19393 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19394 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19395 records in the DNS. For example:
19397 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19399 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19402 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19404 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19405 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19406 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19407 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19408 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19409 happens is controlled by the
19410 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19411 &%self%& option of the router.
19413 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19414 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19415 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19416 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19417 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19418 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19419 defined by MX preferences.
19421 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19422 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19423 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19425 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19426 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19427 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19428 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19430 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19431 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19434 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19435 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19436 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19438 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19439 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19443 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19444 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19445 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19446 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19447 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19448 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19449 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19452 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19453 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19455 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19456 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19458 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19459 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19460 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19462 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19463 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19464 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19469 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19470 domain2 host4:host5
19472 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19473 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19474 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19475 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19478 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19479 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19480 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19481 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19484 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19485 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19490 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19491 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19494 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19495 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19499 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19500 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19501 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19504 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19505 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19506 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19507 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19509 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19511 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19512 your first router something like this:
19515 driver = manualroute
19516 domains = !+local_domains
19517 transport = remote_smtp
19518 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19520 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19521 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19522 they are tried in order
19523 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19524 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19527 driver = manualroute
19528 transport = remote_smtp
19529 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19531 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19532 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19533 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19534 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19535 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19536 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19537 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19538 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19541 .cindex "mail hub example"
19542 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19543 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19544 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19545 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19546 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19547 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19548 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19549 lookup is easier to manage.
19551 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19552 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19556 driver = manualroute
19557 transport = remote_smtp
19558 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19560 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19561 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19562 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19563 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19564 domain can be used to find the host:
19567 driver = manualroute
19568 transport = remote_smtp
19569 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19571 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19572 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19573 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19577 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19578 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19579 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19580 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19581 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19582 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19585 driver = manualroute
19586 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19587 route_list = saved.domain.example
19589 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19590 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19591 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19594 driver = manualroute
19596 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19597 *.saved.domain2.example \
19598 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19601 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19603 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19604 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19605 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19606 the address if the lookup fails.
19609 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19610 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19611 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19612 one way it can be done:
19618 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19619 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19620 return_fail_output = true
19625 driver = manualroute
19627 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19629 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19631 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19633 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19634 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19635 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19637 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19638 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19650 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19651 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19652 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19653 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19654 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19655 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19656 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19657 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19658 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19659 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19661 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19663 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19664 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19665 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19666 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19667 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19670 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19671 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19672 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19673 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19674 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19675 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19678 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19679 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19680 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19681 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19682 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19683 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19684 not set, a value for the gid also.
19686 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19687 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19688 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19689 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19690 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19691 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19695 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19696 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19697 before running the command.
19700 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19701 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19702 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19706 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19707 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19708 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19709 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19710 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19713 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19716 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19717 &%no_more%& is set.
19719 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19720 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19721 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19722 included in the SMTP response.
19724 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19725 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19726 included in any SMTP response.
19728 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19730 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19731 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19733 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19734 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19735 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19738 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19739 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19742 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19743 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19745 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19746 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19747 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19748 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19750 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19751 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19752 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19753 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19754 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19756 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19757 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19758 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19759 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19760 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19762 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19763 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19764 variable. For example, this return line
19766 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19768 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19769 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19770 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19771 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19779 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19780 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19781 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19782 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19783 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19784 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19785 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19786 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19787 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19788 redirected in several different ways:
19791 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19794 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19796 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19798 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19800 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19802 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19804 It can be discarded.
19807 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19808 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19809 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19810 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19812 If success DSNs have been requested
19813 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19814 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19815 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19819 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19820 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19821 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19822 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19823 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19824 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19828 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19830 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19831 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19832 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19833 cause delivery to be deferred.
19835 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19836 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19841 file = $home/.forward
19844 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19845 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19846 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19847 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19852 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19853 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19854 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19855 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19858 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19859 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19860 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19861 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19863 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19864 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19865 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19866 saves some resources.
19874 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19875 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19876 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19877 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19878 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19881 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19882 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19883 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19884 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19885 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19886 document is intended for use by end users.
19888 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19889 described in the next section.
19892 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19893 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19894 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19895 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19896 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19900 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19901 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19902 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19903 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19904 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19905 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19906 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19907 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19908 commas or newlines.
19909 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19912 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19913 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19914 next newline character is ignored.
19916 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19917 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19918 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19919 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19922 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19923 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19924 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19925 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19926 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19927 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19930 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19934 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19935 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19936 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19937 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19938 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19939 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19940 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19941 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19942 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19943 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19944 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19946 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19947 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19948 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19949 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19950 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19952 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19954 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19955 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19956 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19957 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19958 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19961 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19962 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19963 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19964 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19965 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19967 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19968 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19973 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19974 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19977 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19979 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19980 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19981 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19982 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19983 should really contain
19985 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19987 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19988 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19989 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19993 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19994 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19995 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19998 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19999 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20000 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20001 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20002 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20003 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20004 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20006 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20007 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20008 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20009 in double quotes, for example:
20011 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20013 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20014 quote just the command. An item such as
20016 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20018 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20020 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20021 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20022 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20023 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20024 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20025 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20026 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20027 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20028 an &%accept%& router.
20031 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20032 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20033 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20034 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20036 /home/world/minbari
20038 is treated as a file name, but
20040 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20042 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20043 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20044 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20045 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20047 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20048 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20050 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20051 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20052 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20053 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20056 .cindex "included address list"
20057 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20058 If an item is of the form
20060 :include:<path name>
20062 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20063 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20064 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20065 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20066 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20067 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20069 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20071 It must be given as
20073 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20076 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20077 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20078 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20079 .cindex "black hole"
20080 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20081 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20082 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20083 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20087 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20088 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20089 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20091 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20092 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20093 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20094 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20098 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20099 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20100 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20101 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20102 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20103 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20104 redirection items of the form
20109 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20110 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20111 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20112 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20114 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20116 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20118 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20119 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20121 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20122 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20123 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20125 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20126 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20127 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20128 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20129 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20130 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20131 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20132 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20133 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20136 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20137 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20138 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20139 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20141 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20142 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20143 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20144 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20145 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20147 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20148 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20149 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20150 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20151 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20155 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20156 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20157 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20158 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20159 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20160 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20161 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20165 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20166 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20167 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20168 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20169 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20170 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20171 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20172 aliasing scheme of the type
20174 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20178 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20179 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20180 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20183 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20184 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20186 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20187 the pipes are distinct.
20191 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20192 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20193 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20194 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20195 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20196 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20197 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20198 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20199 can be used to avoid this.
20202 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20203 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20204 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20205 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20206 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20207 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20208 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20212 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20214 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20215 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20218 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20219 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20220 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20223 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20224 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20225 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20226 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20229 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20230 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20231 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20232 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20233 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20234 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20235 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20237 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20238 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20241 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20242 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20243 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20244 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20245 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20249 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20250 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20251 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20252 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20253 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20254 let ordinary users do.
20258 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20259 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20260 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20261 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20262 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20263 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20265 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20266 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20267 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20268 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20269 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20270 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20272 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20274 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20275 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20276 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20277 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20278 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20279 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20280 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20281 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20284 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20285 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20286 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20287 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20288 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20289 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20290 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20291 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20295 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20296 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20297 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20298 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20299 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20300 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20303 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20304 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20305 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20306 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20307 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20308 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20310 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20311 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20312 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20314 data = #Exim filter\n\
20315 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20317 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20318 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20319 choice into a newline.
20322 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20323 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20324 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20325 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20326 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20329 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20330 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20331 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20332 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20333 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20334 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20335 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20336 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20338 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20339 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20340 runs a check on the containing directory,
20341 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20342 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20343 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20344 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20345 not, the router declines.
20348 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20349 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20350 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20351 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20352 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20353 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20354 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20357 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20358 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20359 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20360 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20361 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20364 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20365 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20366 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20367 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20371 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20372 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20373 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20374 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20375 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20380 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20381 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20382 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20383 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20384 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20385 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20386 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20387 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20388 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20389 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20390 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20393 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20394 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20395 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20396 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20397 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20400 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20401 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20402 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20403 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20404 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20405 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20407 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20408 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20409 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20410 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20411 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20412 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20413 &_.forward_& files).
20416 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20417 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20418 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20419 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20420 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20423 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20424 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20425 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20426 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20427 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20428 of the embedded Perl support.
20431 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20432 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20433 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20434 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20435 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20438 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20439 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20440 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20441 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20442 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20445 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20446 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20447 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20448 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20449 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20450 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20451 &%one_time%& is set.
20454 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20455 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20456 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20457 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20458 to make use of &%run%& items.
20461 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20462 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20463 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20464 If this option is true, items of the form
20466 :include:<path name>
20468 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20471 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20472 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20473 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20474 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20475 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20476 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20477 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20480 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20481 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20482 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20483 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20484 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20487 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20488 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20489 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20490 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20491 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20496 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20497 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20498 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20499 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20500 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20501 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20502 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20505 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20507 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20508 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20509 file did not exist.
20512 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20514 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20515 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20516 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20518 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20519 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20520 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20521 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20522 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20523 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20524 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20525 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20529 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20530 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20531 redirection list must start with this directory.
20534 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20535 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20536 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20539 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20540 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20541 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20542 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20543 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20544 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20545 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20546 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20547 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20548 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20549 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20550 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20551 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20552 before they subscribed.
20554 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20555 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20556 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20557 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20560 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20561 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20562 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20563 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20565 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20566 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20567 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20569 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20572 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20573 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20574 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20575 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20576 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20580 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20581 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20582 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20583 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20584 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20585 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20586 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20587 See &%check_owner%& above.
20590 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20591 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20592 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20593 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20596 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20597 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20598 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20599 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20600 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20601 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20602 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20605 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20606 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20607 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20608 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20609 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20610 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20611 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20612 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20614 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20615 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20616 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20619 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20620 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20621 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20622 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20623 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20624 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20625 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20626 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20627 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20628 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20631 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20632 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20633 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20634 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20635 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20636 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20639 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20640 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20641 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20642 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20643 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20644 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20647 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20648 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20649 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20650 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20651 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20654 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20655 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20656 :subaddress part of an address.
20658 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20659 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20660 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20661 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20664 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20665 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20666 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20667 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20668 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20669 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20670 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20674 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20675 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20676 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20677 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20678 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20679 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20680 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20681 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20682 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20683 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20684 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20685 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20686 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20687 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20688 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20689 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20691 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20692 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20693 the following routers.
20695 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20696 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20697 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20698 so it is passed to the following routers.
20700 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20701 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20702 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20703 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20705 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20706 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20707 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20708 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20714 file = $home/.forward
20715 file_transport = address_file
20716 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20717 reply_transport = address_reply
20720 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20721 syntax_errors_text = \
20722 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20723 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20724 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20725 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20726 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20727 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20728 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20729 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20730 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20731 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20733 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20734 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20735 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20740 local_part_prefix = real-
20741 transport = local_delivery
20743 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20744 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20746 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20747 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20751 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20752 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20755 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20756 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20757 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20758 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20765 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20768 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20769 "Environment for local transports"
20770 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20771 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20772 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20773 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20774 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20775 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20776 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20778 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20779 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20780 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20781 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20783 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20784 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20785 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20786 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20787 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20791 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20792 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20793 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20794 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20795 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20796 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20797 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20800 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20801 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20805 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20807 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20808 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20809 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20810 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20815 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20816 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20817 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20818 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20819 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20820 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20821 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20822 group (set by the transport). For example:
20825 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20829 transport = group_delivery
20832 # This transport overrides the group
20834 driver = appendfile
20835 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20838 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20839 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20840 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20843 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20844 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20845 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20846 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20847 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20848 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20850 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20851 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20852 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20853 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20854 original gid is also used.
20856 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20857 following that is set is used:
20860 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20862 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20864 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20865 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20867 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20869 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20870 the uid is the creator's uid;
20872 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20875 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20876 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20877 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20878 The first of the following that is set is used:
20881 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20883 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20885 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20887 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20892 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20893 &%never_users%& list.
20899 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20900 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20901 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20902 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20903 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20904 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20905 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20906 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20907 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20908 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20911 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20913 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20915 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20917 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20920 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20923 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20925 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20929 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20930 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20931 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20935 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20936 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20937 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20938 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20939 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20940 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20941 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20942 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20943 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20944 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20945 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20946 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20947 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20948 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20959 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20960 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20961 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20962 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20963 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20966 .option body_only transports boolean false
20967 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20968 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20969 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20970 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20971 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20972 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20973 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20974 automatically suppress them.
20977 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20978 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20979 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20980 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20981 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20982 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20985 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20986 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20987 deliveries by the transport or for any
20988 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20989 what you are doing.
20992 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20993 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20994 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20995 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20997 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20998 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20999 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21000 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21001 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21002 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21004 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21005 transport and the router that called it.
21007 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21008 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21009 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21010 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21011 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21012 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21013 safely be resent to other recipients.
21016 .option driver transports string unset
21017 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21018 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21021 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21022 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21023 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21024 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21025 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21026 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21027 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21028 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21029 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21030 resent to other recipients.
21033 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21035 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21036 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21039 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21040 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21041 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21042 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21043 &%user%& (see below).
21046 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21047 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21048 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21049 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21050 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21051 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21052 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21053 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21054 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21055 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21056 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21058 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21059 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21062 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21063 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21064 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21065 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21066 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21067 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21068 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21069 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21072 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21073 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21074 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21075 This option specifies a list of header names,
21076 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21077 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21078 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21080 Each list item is separately expanded.
21081 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21082 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21083 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21085 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21086 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21088 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21089 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21090 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21094 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21095 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21096 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21097 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21098 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21099 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21100 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21101 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21104 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21107 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21108 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21109 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21110 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21111 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21112 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21113 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21114 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21115 change envelope recipients at this time.
21118 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21119 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21121 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21122 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21123 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21124 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21125 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21126 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21127 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21131 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21132 .cindex "additional groups"
21133 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21134 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21135 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21136 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21137 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21140 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21141 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21142 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21143 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21144 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21145 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21146 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21147 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21149 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21150 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21151 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21152 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21153 Obviously there is scope for
21154 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21155 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21157 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21158 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21159 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21160 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21161 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21164 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21165 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21166 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21167 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21168 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21169 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21170 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21171 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21172 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21173 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21174 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21175 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21176 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21181 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21182 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21183 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21184 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21185 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21186 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21187 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21188 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21191 local_part_prefix = *-
21193 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21196 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21198 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21199 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21200 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21201 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21202 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21205 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21206 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21207 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21208 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21209 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21210 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21211 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21212 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21213 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21215 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21216 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21217 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21218 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21220 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21221 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21222 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21225 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21226 .cindex "envelope sender"
21227 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21228 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21229 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21230 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21231 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21232 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21233 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21234 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21235 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21237 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21238 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21240 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21241 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21242 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21243 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21244 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21245 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21246 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21248 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21249 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21250 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21251 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21252 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21256 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21257 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21258 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21259 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21260 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21261 have easy access to it.
21263 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21264 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21265 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21266 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21267 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21271 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21272 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21275 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21276 .cindex "shadow transport"
21277 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21278 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21279 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21281 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21282 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21283 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21284 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21285 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21286 cause a log line to be written.
21288 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21289 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21290 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21291 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21292 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21295 ST=<shadow transport name>
21297 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21298 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21299 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21300 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21301 headers that some sites insist on.
21304 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21305 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21306 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21307 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21308 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21309 individual users or via a system filter.
21310 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21312 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21313 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21314 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21315 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21316 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21318 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21319 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21320 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21321 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21322 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21323 &(pipe)& transports.
21325 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21326 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21327 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21328 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21329 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21331 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21332 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21333 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21334 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21336 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21337 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21338 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21339 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21340 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21341 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21343 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21344 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21345 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21346 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21347 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21348 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21349 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21350 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21352 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21353 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21354 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21355 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21356 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21357 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21358 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21359 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21360 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21361 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21364 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21365 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21366 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21367 which the message is being sent. For example:
21369 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21370 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21373 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21374 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21375 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21377 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21378 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21379 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21382 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21384 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21385 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21386 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21387 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21388 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21389 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21391 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21392 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21393 arguments. Consider this example:
21395 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21396 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21398 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21399 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21401 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21402 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21406 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21407 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21408 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21409 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21410 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21411 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21412 bounced from a transport filter.
21414 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21415 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21416 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21419 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21420 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21421 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21422 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21423 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21424 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21425 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21426 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21427 becomes a temporary error.
21430 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21431 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21432 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21433 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21434 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21435 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21436 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21439 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21440 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21441 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21443 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21444 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21445 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21446 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21448 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21449 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21450 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21460 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21462 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21463 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21464 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21465 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21466 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21467 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21468 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21470 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21471 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21472 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21473 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21474 local transport, for example:
21477 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21478 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21479 recipients saves space.
21481 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21482 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21484 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21485 to a scanner program or
21486 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21490 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21491 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21492 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21494 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21495 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21496 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21497 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21498 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21499 to certain conditions:
21502 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21503 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21504 batching is possible.
21506 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21507 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21508 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21510 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21511 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21512 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21513 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21514 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21517 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21518 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21519 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21523 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21524 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21525 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21526 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21527 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21528 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21529 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21532 escape_string = ".."
21534 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21535 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21536 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21538 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21539 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21540 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21541 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21542 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21543 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21545 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21546 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21547 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21548 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21549 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21550 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21551 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21552 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21553 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21561 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21562 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21563 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21564 .cindex "directory creation"
21565 .cindex "creating directories"
21566 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21567 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21568 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21569 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21570 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21571 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21572 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21573 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21574 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21575 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21577 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21578 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21579 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21582 .cindex "quota" "system"
21583 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21584 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21585 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21587 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21588 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21589 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21590 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21592 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21593 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21596 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21597 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21598 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21599 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21604 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21605 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21606 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21607 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21608 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21610 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21611 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21612 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21613 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21614 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21615 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21616 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21617 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21618 operation. There are two cases:
21621 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21622 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21623 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21624 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21625 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21626 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21627 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21629 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21630 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21631 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21635 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21636 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21637 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21638 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21643 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21645 require "fileinto";
21646 fileinto "folder23";
21648 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21649 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21650 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21651 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21652 way of handling this requirement:
21654 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21655 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21656 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21658 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21662 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21663 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21664 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21666 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21667 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21668 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21669 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21670 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21671 path to the transport.
21673 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21674 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21679 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21680 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21684 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21685 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21686 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21687 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21688 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21689 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21690 delivery is deferred.
21693 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21694 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21695 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21696 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21697 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21698 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21699 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21700 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21703 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21704 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21705 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21706 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21710 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21711 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21714 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21715 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21716 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21717 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21718 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21721 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21722 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21723 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21724 process is running.
21727 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21728 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21729 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21730 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21731 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21732 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21733 contains is significant.
21735 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21736 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21737 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21738 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21739 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21741 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21742 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21743 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21744 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21745 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21746 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21748 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21749 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21750 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21751 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21753 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21754 .cindex "directory creation"
21755 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21756 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21757 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21759 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21760 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21761 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21762 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21763 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21767 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21768 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21769 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21770 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21771 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21774 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21775 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21776 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21777 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21778 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21779 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21780 &%file_must_exist%&.
21783 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21784 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21785 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21786 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21788 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21789 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21790 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21791 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21792 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21795 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21797 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21798 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21799 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21800 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21802 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21804 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21805 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21809 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21810 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21811 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21814 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21815 See &%check_string%& above.
21818 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21819 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21820 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21821 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21822 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21823 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21826 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21827 .cindex "locking files"
21828 .cindex "lock files"
21829 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21830 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21832 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21833 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21836 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21837 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21840 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21841 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21842 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21843 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21844 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21845 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21849 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21850 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21851 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21852 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21853 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21854 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21855 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21856 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21857 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21860 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21861 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21863 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21864 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21865 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21866 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21867 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21868 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21869 delivery is deferred.
21872 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21873 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21874 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21875 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21878 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21879 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21880 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21881 .cindex "locking files"
21882 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21883 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21884 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21885 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21886 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21887 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21888 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21889 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21891 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21892 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21893 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21894 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21896 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21897 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21900 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21902 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21903 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21904 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21906 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21907 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21909 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21912 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21913 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21914 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21915 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21918 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21919 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21920 for details of locking.
21923 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21924 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21925 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21928 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21929 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21930 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21933 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21934 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21935 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21936 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21937 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21940 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21941 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21942 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21943 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21944 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21945 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21946 external source that maintains the data.
21949 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21950 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21951 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21952 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21953 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21954 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21955 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21956 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21960 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21961 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21962 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21963 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21964 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21965 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21966 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21967 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21968 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21969 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21972 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21973 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21974 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21975 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21976 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21977 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21978 calculation. The default value is:
21980 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21982 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21983 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21985 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21987 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21989 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21990 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21991 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21992 directly into that directory.
21995 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21996 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21997 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22000 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22001 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22002 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22005 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22006 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22007 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22008 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22009 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22010 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22011 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22012 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22014 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22015 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22016 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22017 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22018 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22019 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22020 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22021 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22022 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22023 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22026 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22027 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22028 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22029 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22030 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22031 below for further details.
22034 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22035 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22036 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22039 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22040 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22041 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22044 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22045 .cindex "locking files"
22046 .cindex "file" "locking"
22047 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22048 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22049 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22050 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22051 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22052 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22053 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22055 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22056 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22057 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22064 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22065 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22066 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22067 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22068 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22069 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22070 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22071 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22073 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22074 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22075 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22076 append messages to it.
22079 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22080 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22081 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22082 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22083 in which case it is:
22085 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22086 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22088 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22089 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22091 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22092 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22093 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22094 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22099 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22100 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22102 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22103 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22104 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22105 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22106 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22107 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22108 value, and this option is ignored.
22111 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22112 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22113 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22114 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22115 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22118 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22119 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22120 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22121 on users about incoming mail.
22124 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22125 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22126 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22127 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22128 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22129 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22130 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22131 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22132 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22134 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22135 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22136 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22138 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22139 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22140 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22141 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22142 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22143 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22145 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22146 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22147 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22148 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22149 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22152 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22153 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22155 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22157 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22158 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22159 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22160 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22161 system quota failures.
22163 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22164 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22165 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22166 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22167 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22168 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22169 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22170 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22171 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22172 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22175 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22176 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22177 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22178 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22179 delivery directory.
22182 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22183 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22184 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22185 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22186 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22189 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22190 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22192 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22193 See &%quota%& above.
22196 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22197 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22198 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22199 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22200 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22201 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22202 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22204 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22205 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22206 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22207 the file length to the file name. For example:
22209 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22210 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22212 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22213 number of lines in the message.
22215 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22216 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22217 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22219 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22222 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22223 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22224 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22226 quota_warn_message = "\
22227 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22228 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22229 This message is automatically created \
22230 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22231 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22232 a warning threshold that is\n\
22233 set by the system administrator.\n"
22237 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22238 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22239 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22240 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22241 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22242 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22243 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22244 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22245 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22249 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22251 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22252 percent sign is ignored.
22254 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22255 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22256 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22257 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22258 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22259 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22261 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22263 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22264 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22267 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22268 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22272 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22273 .cindex "envelope sender"
22274 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22275 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22276 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22277 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22278 for details of batch SMTP.
22281 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22282 .cindex "carriage return"
22284 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22285 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22286 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22287 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22289 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22290 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22291 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22292 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22293 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22294 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22297 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22298 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22299 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22300 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22301 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22302 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22305 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22306 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22307 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22308 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22309 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22311 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22312 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22313 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22314 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22316 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22317 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22318 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22319 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22320 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22323 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22324 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22327 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22328 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22329 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22330 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22331 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22332 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22333 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22335 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22336 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22337 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22338 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22341 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22342 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22343 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22346 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22347 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22348 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22349 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22350 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22351 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22352 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22353 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22354 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22356 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22357 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22358 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22359 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22364 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22365 .cindex "appending to a file"
22366 .cindex "file" "appending"
22367 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22370 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22374 .cindex "directory creation"
22375 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22376 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22377 &%directory_mode%& option.
22380 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22381 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22385 .cindex "file" "locking"
22386 .cindex "locking files"
22387 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22388 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22389 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22392 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22393 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22394 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22396 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22398 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22399 Unlink the hitching post name.
22401 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22402 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22403 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22404 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22406 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22407 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22408 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22409 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22410 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22411 it before trying again.
22415 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22416 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22417 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22420 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22421 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22422 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22423 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22424 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22425 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22426 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22427 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22428 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22432 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22433 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22434 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22435 delivery is deferred.
22438 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22439 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22440 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22444 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22445 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22446 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22449 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22450 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22451 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22454 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22455 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22456 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22457 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22458 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22459 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22460 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22461 that prevents link following.
22464 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22465 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22466 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22467 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22468 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22471 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22474 .cindex "file" "locking"
22475 .cindex "locking files"
22476 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22477 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22478 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22479 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22480 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22482 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22484 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22485 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22486 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22488 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22489 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22490 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22492 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22493 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22494 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22495 delivery is deferred.
22497 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22498 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22499 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22500 immediately. It retries up to
22502 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22504 times (rounded up).
22507 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22508 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22511 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22512 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22513 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22514 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22515 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22516 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22517 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22518 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22519 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22520 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22522 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22523 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22524 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22525 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22526 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22527 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22528 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22530 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22531 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22532 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22533 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22536 .cindex "maildir format"
22537 .cindex "mailstore format"
22538 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22539 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22540 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22541 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22542 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22544 .cindex "directory creation"
22545 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22546 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22547 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22548 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22549 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22550 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22555 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22556 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22557 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22558 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22559 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22560 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22561 &_new_& subdirectory.
22563 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22564 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22565 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22566 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22567 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22568 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22569 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22571 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22572 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22573 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22574 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22575 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22576 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22577 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22578 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22580 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22581 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22582 folders. Consider this example:
22584 maildir_format = true
22585 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22586 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22587 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22588 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22590 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22591 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22592 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22593 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22594 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22595 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22597 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22598 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22599 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22600 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22601 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22603 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22604 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22605 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22607 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22608 .cindex "maildir++"
22609 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22610 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22611 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22612 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22613 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22614 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22615 amount of space used.
22617 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22618 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22619 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22620 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22621 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22622 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22627 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22628 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22629 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22630 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22631 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22632 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22635 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22636 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22637 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22638 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22639 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22640 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22641 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22642 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22643 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22644 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22645 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22646 backwards compatibility).
22648 For one common implementation, you might set:
22650 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22652 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22654 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22655 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22656 &[stat()]& each message file.
22659 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22660 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22661 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22662 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22663 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22664 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22665 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22666 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22667 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22669 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22670 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22671 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22672 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22673 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22674 need to know the quota.
22676 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22677 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22679 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22680 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22681 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22685 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22686 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22687 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22688 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22689 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22690 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22691 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22692 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22694 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22695 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22696 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22697 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22698 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22699 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22701 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22702 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22703 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22704 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22705 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22706 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22708 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22709 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22710 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22711 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22714 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22715 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22716 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22717 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22718 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22720 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22722 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22723 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22724 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22725 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22726 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22736 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22737 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22738 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22739 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22740 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22741 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22742 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22743 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22745 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22746 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22747 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22748 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22749 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22752 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22753 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22754 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22755 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22756 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22758 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22759 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22760 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22761 transport is run as a consequence of a
22763 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22764 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22765 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22766 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22767 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22768 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22770 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22771 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22772 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22773 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22775 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22776 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22777 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22778 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22779 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22780 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22781 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22783 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22784 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22785 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22786 the transport defers.
22787 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22788 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22790 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22791 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22792 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22793 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22795 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22796 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22797 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22798 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22799 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22800 problems. They are just discarded.
22804 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22805 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22807 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22808 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22809 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22812 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22813 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22814 when the message is specified by the transport.
22817 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22818 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22819 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22820 string comes first.
22823 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22824 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22825 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22828 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22829 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22830 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22833 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22834 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22835 specified by the transport.
22838 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22839 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22840 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22841 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22844 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22845 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22846 the message is specified by the transport.
22849 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22850 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22854 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22855 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22856 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22857 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22858 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22862 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22863 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22864 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22865 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22867 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22868 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22869 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22870 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22871 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22872 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22873 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22876 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22877 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22878 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22879 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22880 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22882 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22883 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22884 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22885 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22886 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22887 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22890 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22891 See &%once%& above.
22894 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22895 See &%once%& above.
22896 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22899 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22900 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22901 specified by the transport.
22904 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22905 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22906 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22907 configuration option.
22910 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22911 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22912 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22913 automatic responses. For example:
22915 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22917 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22918 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22919 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22920 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22925 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22926 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22927 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22928 the text comes first.
22931 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22932 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22933 when the message is specified by the transport.
22934 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22935 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22940 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22943 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22944 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22945 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22946 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22947 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22948 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22950 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22951 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22952 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22953 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22954 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22955 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22959 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22960 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22961 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22964 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22965 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22968 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22969 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22970 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22971 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22972 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22975 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22976 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22977 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22978 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22979 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22980 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22983 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22984 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22985 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22986 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22987 in its response to the LHLO command.
22989 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22990 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22991 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22992 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22995 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22996 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22997 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22998 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23003 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23007 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23008 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23012 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23013 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23015 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23016 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23017 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23018 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23019 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23020 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23021 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23022 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23026 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23027 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23028 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23029 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23030 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23032 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23033 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23034 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23035 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23036 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23037 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23038 that are routed to the transport.
23040 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23041 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23042 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23043 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23044 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23045 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23046 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23050 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23051 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23052 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23054 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23055 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23056 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23057 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23058 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23059 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23060 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23063 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23064 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23065 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23066 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23067 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23068 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23069 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23074 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23075 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23076 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23077 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23078 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23079 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23080 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23081 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23082 &"local delivery failed"&.
23084 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23085 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23086 will be sent as normal.
23088 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23089 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23090 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23091 apply in this case.
23093 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23094 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23095 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23096 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23098 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23099 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23100 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23101 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23102 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23103 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23104 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23109 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23110 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23111 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23112 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23113 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23116 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23117 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23118 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23119 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23121 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23122 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23123 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23124 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23125 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23127 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23129 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23130 arguments. You have to write
23132 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23134 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23135 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23136 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23137 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23138 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23139 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23142 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23145 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23146 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23147 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23148 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23149 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23150 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23151 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23152 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23153 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23154 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23156 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23157 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23158 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23159 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23160 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23161 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23162 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23163 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23165 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23166 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23167 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23168 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23169 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23170 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23171 control what is done with it.
23173 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23174 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23175 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23176 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23177 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23178 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23179 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23180 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23181 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23182 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23183 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23187 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23188 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23189 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23190 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23191 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23192 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23193 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23194 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23196 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23197 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23198 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23199 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23200 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23201 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23202 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23203 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23204 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23205 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23206 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23207 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23208 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23209 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23210 &`USER `& see below
23212 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23213 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23214 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23215 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23216 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23217 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23218 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23221 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23222 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23223 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23227 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23228 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23229 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23230 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23233 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23234 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23238 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23239 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23240 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23241 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23242 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23243 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23244 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23245 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23246 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23247 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23248 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23251 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23253 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23254 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23255 &%use_shell%& is set.
23258 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23259 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23262 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23263 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23264 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23267 .option check_string pipe string unset
23268 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23269 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23270 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23271 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23272 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23273 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23274 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23278 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23279 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23280 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23281 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23282 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23283 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23284 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23287 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23288 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23289 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23290 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23291 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23292 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23293 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23296 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23297 See &%check_string%& above.
23300 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23301 .cindex "exec failure"
23302 .cindex "failure of exec"
23303 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23304 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23305 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23306 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23307 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23310 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23311 .cindex "signal exit"
23312 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23313 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23314 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23315 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23318 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23319 .cindex "force command"
23320 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23321 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23322 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23323 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23324 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23325 command. For example:
23327 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23331 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23332 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23333 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23336 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23337 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23338 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23339 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23340 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23341 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23343 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23344 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23347 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23348 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23349 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23350 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23351 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23352 written to the main log.
23355 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23356 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23357 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23358 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23359 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23360 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23364 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23365 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23366 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23367 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23368 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23371 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23372 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23373 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23374 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23375 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23376 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23377 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23378 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23381 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23382 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23383 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23386 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23390 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23391 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23392 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23393 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23394 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23399 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23400 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23403 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23404 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23405 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23406 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23410 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23411 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23414 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23415 This option is expanded and
23416 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23417 variable of the subprocess.
23418 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23419 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23420 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23423 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23424 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23425 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23426 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23427 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23428 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23429 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23430 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23431 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23434 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23435 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23436 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23437 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23438 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23439 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23440 accept the message is used.
23443 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23444 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23445 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23446 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23447 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23448 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23451 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23452 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23453 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23454 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23455 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23456 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23457 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23461 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23462 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23463 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23464 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23465 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23466 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23467 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23468 of them may be set.
23472 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23473 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23474 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23475 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23476 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23477 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23478 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23479 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23480 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23481 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23482 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23483 and 73, respectively.
23486 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23487 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23488 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23489 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23490 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23491 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23492 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23494 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23495 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23496 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23497 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23498 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23499 delivery to be deferred.
23501 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23502 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23505 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23506 .cindex "envelope sender"
23507 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23508 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23509 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23510 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23511 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23513 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23514 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23515 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23516 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23517 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23518 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23522 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23523 .cindex "carriage return"
23525 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23526 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23527 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23528 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23530 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23531 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23532 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23533 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23534 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23537 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23538 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23539 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23540 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23541 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23542 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23543 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23544 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23545 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23550 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23551 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23552 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23553 .cindex "external local delivery"
23554 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23555 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23556 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23557 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23558 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23559 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23560 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23561 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23562 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23563 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23568 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23572 check_string = "From "
23573 escape_string = ">From "
23582 transport = procmail_pipe
23584 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23585 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23586 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23587 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23588 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23589 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23591 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23595 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23596 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23599 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23600 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23603 local_delivery_cyrus:
23605 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23606 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23618 local_part_suffix = .*
23619 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23621 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23622 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23624 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23625 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23631 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23632 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23633 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23634 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23635 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23636 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23637 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23638 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23641 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23642 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23646 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23647 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23648 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23649 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23650 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23651 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23652 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23654 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23655 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23656 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23657 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23658 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23659 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23664 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23665 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23666 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23670 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23672 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23673 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23674 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23675 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23676 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23677 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23678 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23679 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23682 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23683 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23684 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23685 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23686 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23687 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23688 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23689 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23690 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23691 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23692 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23693 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23694 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23695 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23697 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23698 and will be removed in a future release.
23701 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23702 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23703 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23706 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23707 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23708 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23709 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23710 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23711 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23712 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23713 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23715 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23716 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23717 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23718 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23719 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23720 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23721 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23722 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23723 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23726 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23728 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23729 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23730 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23731 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23732 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23735 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23736 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23737 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23738 particular connection.
23740 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23741 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23742 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23743 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23745 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23746 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23747 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23749 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23751 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23752 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23754 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23755 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23759 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23760 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23761 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23762 authenticated as a client.
23765 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23766 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23767 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23768 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23771 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23772 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23773 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23774 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23775 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23776 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23777 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23780 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23781 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23782 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23783 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23784 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23785 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23786 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23790 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23791 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23792 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23793 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23796 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23797 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23798 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23799 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23800 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23801 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
23802 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23803 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23806 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23807 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23808 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23811 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23812 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23813 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23814 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23815 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23816 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23818 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23819 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23820 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23821 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23822 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23823 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23824 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23825 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23829 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23830 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23831 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23832 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23833 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23836 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23837 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23838 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23839 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23843 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23844 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23845 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23846 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23847 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23848 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23849 the dnssec request bit set.
23850 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23854 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23855 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23856 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23857 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23858 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23859 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
23860 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23861 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23862 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23866 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23867 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23868 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23869 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23870 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23871 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23872 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23874 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23875 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23876 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23877 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23878 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23881 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23882 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23883 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23884 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23885 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23886 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23887 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23888 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23890 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23891 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23892 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23893 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23894 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23895 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23897 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23898 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23899 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23900 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23901 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23903 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23904 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23905 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23906 copy of the message is sent.
23908 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23909 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23910 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23911 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23915 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23916 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23917 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23920 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23921 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23922 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23923 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23924 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23925 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23927 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23928 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23929 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23930 implementations of TLS.
23932 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23933 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23934 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23935 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23936 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23937 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23938 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23943 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23944 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23945 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23946 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23947 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23948 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23949 interface address, you could use this:
23951 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23952 {$primary_hostname}}
23954 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23957 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23958 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23959 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23960 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23961 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23962 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23964 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23965 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23966 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23967 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23969 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23970 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23971 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23972 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23973 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23974 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23975 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23977 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23978 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23979 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23980 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23981 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23982 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23983 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23986 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23987 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23990 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23991 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23992 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23993 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23994 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23995 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23996 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23997 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23998 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23999 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24002 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24003 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24004 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24005 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24008 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24009 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24010 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24011 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24013 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24014 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24015 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24016 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24017 to any host that matches this list.
24020 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24021 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24022 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24023 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24024 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24025 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24026 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24027 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24030 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24031 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24032 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24037 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24038 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24039 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24040 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24041 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24042 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24043 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24044 explanation of when this might be needed.
24047 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24048 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24049 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24050 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24051 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24052 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24053 message on the same session.
24055 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24056 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24057 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24058 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24059 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24060 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24066 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24067 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24068 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24069 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24070 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24073 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24074 .cindex "randomized host list"
24075 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24076 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24077 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24078 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24079 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24080 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24081 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24082 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24084 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24085 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24086 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24087 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24089 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24091 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24092 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24093 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24095 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24096 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24097 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24098 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24099 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24100 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24101 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24102 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24103 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24106 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24107 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24108 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24109 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24110 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24112 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24113 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24114 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24115 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24116 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24118 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24119 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24120 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24121 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24122 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24123 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24125 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24126 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24127 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24128 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24129 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24130 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24131 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24133 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24134 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24135 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24136 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24137 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24138 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24139 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24141 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list!!" unset
24142 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24143 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24144 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24145 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24146 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24147 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24148 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24149 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24150 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24152 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24153 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24155 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24156 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24158 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24159 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24160 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24161 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24162 for multi-recipient messages.
24163 The option can usually be left as default.
24165 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24166 .cindex "bind IP address"
24167 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24169 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24170 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24171 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24172 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24173 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24174 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24175 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24176 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24179 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24180 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24181 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24182 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24183 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24184 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24186 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24188 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24189 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24190 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24191 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24194 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24195 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24196 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24197 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24198 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24199 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24200 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24201 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24202 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24203 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24207 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24208 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24209 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24210 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24211 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24213 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24214 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24215 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24216 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24217 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24221 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24222 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24223 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24224 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24225 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24226 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24227 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24228 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24230 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24231 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24232 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24234 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24235 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24236 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24237 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24238 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24239 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24240 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24241 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24243 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24244 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24245 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24246 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24251 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24252 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24253 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24254 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24256 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24257 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24258 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24259 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24260 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24262 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24263 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24264 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24265 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24268 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24269 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24270 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24271 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24272 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24273 addresses is not affected.
24275 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24276 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24277 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24278 Exim to use only the host name.
24279 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24282 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24283 .cindex "serializing connections"
24284 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24285 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24286 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24287 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24288 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24289 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24290 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24292 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24293 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24294 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24295 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24296 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24297 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24299 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24300 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24301 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24302 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24303 are used for ETRN serialization.
24305 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24308 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24309 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24310 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24311 .cindex "size" "of message"
24312 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24313 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24314 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24315 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24316 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24317 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24318 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24319 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24321 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24322 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24325 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24326 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24327 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24328 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24331 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24332 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24333 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24335 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24336 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24337 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24338 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24339 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24342 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24343 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24344 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24345 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24349 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24350 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24351 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24352 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24353 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24356 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24357 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24358 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24359 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24360 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24361 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24364 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24367 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24368 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24370 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24371 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24372 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24373 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24374 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24375 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24376 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24377 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24380 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24381 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24382 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24384 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24385 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24386 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24387 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24388 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24389 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24390 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24391 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24392 ciphers is a preference order.
24396 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24397 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24398 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24399 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24400 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24401 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24402 certificate and private key for the session.
24404 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24406 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24412 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24413 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24414 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24415 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24416 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24417 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24418 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24419 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24420 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24421 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24425 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24426 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24427 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24428 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24429 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24430 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24431 Note that unless the host is in this list
24432 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24433 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24434 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24435 certificate verification succeeds.
24438 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24439 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24440 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24441 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24442 while verifying the server certificate,
24443 checks will be included on the host name
24444 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24445 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24446 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24448 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24451 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24452 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24453 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24455 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24456 The value of this option must be either the
24458 or the absolute path to
24459 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24460 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24462 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24463 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24464 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24467 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24468 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24470 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24472 either by file or directory
24473 are added to those given by the system default location.
24475 The values of &$host$& and
24476 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24477 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24479 For back-compatibility,
24480 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24481 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24482 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24485 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24486 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24487 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24488 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24489 certificate verification must succeed.
24490 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24491 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24492 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24497 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24499 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24500 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24501 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24502 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24503 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24506 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24507 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24508 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24509 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24512 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24513 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24514 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24516 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24517 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24518 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24519 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24520 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24522 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24523 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24524 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24525 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24526 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24527 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24528 see below for an exception).
24530 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24531 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24532 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24533 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24534 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24536 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24537 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24538 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24539 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24540 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24541 reached their retry times.
24543 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24544 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24545 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24546 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24547 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24548 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24549 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24550 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24551 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24552 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24555 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24556 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24557 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24558 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24559 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24560 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24562 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24563 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24564 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24565 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24566 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24567 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24576 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24577 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24578 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24579 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24580 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24581 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24583 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24584 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24585 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24586 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24587 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24588 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24589 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24591 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24592 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24593 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24594 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24597 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24598 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24599 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24600 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24602 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24603 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24604 facility; you do not have to use it.
24606 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24607 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24608 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24609 address to which it applies.
24611 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24612 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24613 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24614 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24615 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24616 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24619 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24620 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24621 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24622 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24625 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24626 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24627 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24628 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24629 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24632 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24633 illustrated by these examples:
24636 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24637 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24638 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24639 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24641 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24642 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24647 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24648 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24649 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24650 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24651 message's processing.
24653 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24654 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24655 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24656 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24657 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24658 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24659 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24660 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24661 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24663 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24664 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24665 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24666 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24667 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24668 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24669 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24670 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24671 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24672 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24674 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24675 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24676 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24677 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24678 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24679 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24681 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24682 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24683 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24685 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24686 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24687 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24688 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24689 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24690 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24691 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24692 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24693 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24695 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24696 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24702 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24703 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24704 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24705 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24706 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24707 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24708 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24709 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24710 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24711 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24713 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24715 might produce the output
24717 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24718 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24719 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24720 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24721 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24722 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24723 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24724 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24726 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24727 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24728 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24729 set for a particular transport.
24732 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24733 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24734 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24737 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24739 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24740 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24741 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24742 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24744 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24745 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24746 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24747 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24750 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24751 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24752 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24754 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24755 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24756 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24757 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24758 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24759 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24760 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24762 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24763 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24764 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24765 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24766 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24770 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24771 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24774 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24775 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24776 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24777 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24778 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24779 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24780 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24781 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24782 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24784 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24785 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24786 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24788 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24789 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24790 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24791 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24792 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24793 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24794 of pattern they are set as follows:
24797 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24798 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24799 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24802 *queen@*.fict.example
24804 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24806 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24810 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24811 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24814 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24815 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24816 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24817 rewriting rule of the form
24819 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24821 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24827 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24828 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24829 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24830 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24831 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24835 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24836 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24837 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24838 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24839 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24841 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24843 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24846 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24847 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24848 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24849 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24850 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24851 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24852 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24853 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24854 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24855 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24856 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24857 entry written to the panic log.
24861 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24862 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24865 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24868 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24870 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24873 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24874 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24878 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24880 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24881 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24882 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24883 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24884 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24885 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24887 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24888 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24889 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24890 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24891 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24892 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24893 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24894 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24895 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24896 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24898 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24899 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24900 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24902 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24903 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24906 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24907 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24908 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24909 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24910 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24911 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24912 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24913 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24914 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24916 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24917 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24918 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24919 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24920 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24921 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24922 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24923 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24926 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24927 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24928 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24929 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24932 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24933 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24934 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24936 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24937 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24938 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24939 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24941 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24942 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24943 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24945 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24946 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24947 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24948 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24950 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24954 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24957 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24958 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24959 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24960 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24961 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24962 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24963 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24964 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24966 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24967 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24971 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24972 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24974 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24975 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24976 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24978 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24979 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24980 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24981 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24982 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24983 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24984 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24985 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24987 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24988 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24990 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24992 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24993 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24995 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24996 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24997 messages that originate outside the local host:
24999 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25000 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25002 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25005 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25006 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25007 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25008 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25009 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25010 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25011 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25012 components. For example, the rule
25014 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25016 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25017 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25018 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25019 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25020 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25021 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25022 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25032 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25033 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25034 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25035 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25036 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25037 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25038 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25039 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25040 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25041 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25042 address, domain and error.
25044 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25045 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25046 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25047 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25048 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25049 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25050 log selector is set, the message
25051 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25052 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25053 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25054 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25056 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25057 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25058 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25059 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25060 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25061 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25062 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25063 domain are maintained independently.
25065 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25066 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25067 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25068 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25069 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25070 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25071 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25072 the local address is reached.
25074 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25075 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25076 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25077 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25078 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25080 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25081 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25082 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25083 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25084 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25085 messages that it should now be retaining.
25089 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25090 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25091 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25092 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25093 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25094 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25095 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25096 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25097 message's sender, respectively.
25100 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25101 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25102 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25103 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25104 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25105 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25108 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25110 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25113 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25115 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25116 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25119 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25120 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25121 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25122 expressions work in address lists.
25124 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25125 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25129 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25130 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25131 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25132 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25133 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25134 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25135 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25136 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25137 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25139 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25140 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25141 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25142 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25145 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25146 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25147 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25148 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25149 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25150 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25151 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25152 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25153 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25154 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25159 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25161 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25162 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25163 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25164 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25165 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25166 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25168 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25172 and the retry rules are
25174 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25175 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25177 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25178 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25179 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25180 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25181 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25182 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25184 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25185 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25186 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25187 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25189 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25190 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25191 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25193 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25195 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25196 textual form of the IP address.
25198 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25199 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25200 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25201 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25204 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25205 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25206 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25208 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25209 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25210 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25212 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25213 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25215 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25216 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25219 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25220 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25221 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25222 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25223 retry rule of this form:
25225 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25227 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25228 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25231 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25232 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25233 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25234 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25237 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25238 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25239 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25240 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25241 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25243 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25244 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25246 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25247 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25250 A connection was refused.
25252 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25253 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25255 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25256 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25258 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25259 A connection attempt timed out.
25261 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25262 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25263 obtained from an MX record.
25265 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25266 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25267 obtained from an MX record.
25270 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25272 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25273 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25274 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25275 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25278 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25281 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25282 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25283 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25284 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25285 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25286 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25290 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25291 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25292 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25293 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25294 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25298 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25299 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25300 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25302 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25303 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25304 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25305 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25306 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25307 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25308 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25310 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25311 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25314 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25315 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25316 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25321 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25322 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25323 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25324 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25325 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25328 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25330 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25332 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25334 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25335 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25338 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25340 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25341 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25342 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25343 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25344 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25346 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25347 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25349 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25351 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25352 list is never matched.
25358 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25359 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25360 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25361 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25363 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25365 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25366 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25367 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25368 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25369 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25371 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25372 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25373 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25374 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25375 The available algorithms are:
25378 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25381 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25382 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25383 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25385 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25386 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25387 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25388 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25389 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25390 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25391 queue processing times.
25394 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25395 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25396 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25397 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25398 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25399 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25400 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25401 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25402 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25403 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25404 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25405 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25407 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25408 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25409 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25410 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25411 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25412 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25415 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25416 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25417 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25418 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25419 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25420 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25421 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25422 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25423 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25424 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25425 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25426 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25428 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25429 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25430 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25431 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25432 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25433 deliveries that have been deferred.
25436 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25437 Here are some example retry rules:
25439 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25440 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25441 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25442 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25443 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25444 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25446 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25447 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25448 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25449 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25450 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25451 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25452 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25455 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25456 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25457 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25458 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25459 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25461 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25462 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25463 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25464 were not obtained from an MX record.
25466 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25467 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25468 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25469 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25470 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25474 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25475 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25476 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25477 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25478 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25479 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25480 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25481 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25482 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25483 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25484 failing for the first time.
25486 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25487 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25488 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25489 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25491 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25492 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25493 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25498 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25499 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25500 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25501 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25502 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25503 default retry rule:
25505 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25507 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25508 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25509 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25511 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25512 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25513 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25514 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25515 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25517 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25518 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25519 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25521 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25522 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25523 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25524 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25525 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25526 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25527 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25528 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25530 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25531 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25532 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25533 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25534 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25537 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25538 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25539 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25540 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25541 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25542 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25543 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25544 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25545 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25548 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25549 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25550 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25551 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25552 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25553 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25554 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25555 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25558 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25559 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25560 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25561 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25562 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25563 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25564 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25565 time out the address.
25567 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25568 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25569 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25570 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25571 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25572 considered immediately.
25573 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25574 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25584 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25585 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25586 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25587 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25588 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25589 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25590 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25591 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25592 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25595 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25596 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25599 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25600 the client's EHLO command.
25602 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25603 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25605 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25606 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25607 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25608 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25609 with the AUTH command.
25611 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25613 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25614 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25615 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25618 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25619 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25620 unauthenticated connection.
25623 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25624 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25625 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25626 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25628 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25629 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25630 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25631 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25632 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25633 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25634 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25635 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25640 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25641 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25642 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25643 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25644 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25645 included by setting
25648 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25651 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25656 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25657 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25658 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25659 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25660 work via a socket interface.
25661 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25662 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25663 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25664 supporting setting a server keytab.
25665 The sixth can be configured to support
25666 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25667 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25668 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25669 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25670 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25672 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25673 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25674 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25675 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25676 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25677 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25678 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25680 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25681 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25682 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25683 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25684 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25685 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25689 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25690 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25692 client_secret = secret2
25694 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25695 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25697 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25698 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25699 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25702 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25703 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25704 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25705 authenticating data.
25707 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25708 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25709 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25710 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25711 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25712 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25713 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25714 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25715 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25716 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25719 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25720 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25721 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25722 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25726 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25727 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25728 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25730 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25731 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25732 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25733 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25734 encrypted by a setting such as:
25736 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25740 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25741 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25742 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25743 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25746 .option driver authenticators string unset
25747 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25748 authenticators is to be used.
25751 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25752 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25753 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25754 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25755 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25756 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25759 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25760 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25761 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25762 mechanism is not advertised.
25763 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25764 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25765 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25768 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25769 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25770 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25773 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25774 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25776 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25777 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25778 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25779 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25780 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25781 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25782 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25783 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25784 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25788 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25789 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25790 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25791 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25792 out the values of variables.
25793 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25794 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25797 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25798 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25799 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25800 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25801 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25802 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25803 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25804 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25805 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25808 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25809 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25810 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25811 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25812 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25813 remembered for later use.
25814 How it is used is described in the following section.
25820 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25821 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25822 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25823 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25824 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25828 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25829 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25831 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25833 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25834 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25835 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25836 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25837 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25838 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25839 given for the MAIL command.
25841 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25842 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25845 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25846 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25847 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25848 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25849 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25850 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25851 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25856 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25857 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25858 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25859 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25861 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25862 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25863 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25864 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25865 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25870 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25871 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25872 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25873 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25877 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25879 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25880 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25883 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25884 the mechanisms are advertised.
25886 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25887 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25888 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25889 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25890 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25891 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25892 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25894 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25896 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25898 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25899 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25900 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25903 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25905 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25906 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25907 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25909 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25910 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25911 command. This is the case if
25914 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25916 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25918 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25919 server authenticators.
25923 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25924 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25925 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25927 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25928 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25929 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25930 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25931 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25932 rejected with a 504 error.
25934 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25935 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25936 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25937 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25938 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25939 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25940 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25941 no successful authentication.
25946 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25947 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25948 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25949 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25950 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25951 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25952 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25956 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25958 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25959 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25960 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25961 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25962 command line to run this script on such data might be
25964 encode '\0user\0password'
25966 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25967 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25968 whose code value is zero.
25970 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25971 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25972 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25973 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25975 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25976 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25977 example, a command such as
25979 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25981 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25983 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25984 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25986 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25988 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25989 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25990 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25991 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25995 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25996 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25997 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25998 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25999 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26000 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26003 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26004 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26005 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26006 of the authenticator.
26009 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26010 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26011 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26012 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26013 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26014 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26015 delivery to be deferred.
26017 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26018 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26019 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26022 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26023 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26024 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26025 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26026 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26027 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26028 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26029 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26030 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26033 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26034 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26035 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26036 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26037 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26038 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26039 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26040 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26042 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26044 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26045 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26046 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26047 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26048 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26049 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26050 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26051 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26052 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26053 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26054 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26055 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26056 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26064 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26066 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26067 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26068 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26069 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26070 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26071 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26072 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26073 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26074 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26075 connections as you do for login accounts.
26077 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26078 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26079 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26081 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26082 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26083 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26085 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26086 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26087 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26090 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26091 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26092 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26093 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26094 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26095 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26096 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26098 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26099 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26100 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26101 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26102 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26103 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26104 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26106 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26107 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26108 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26109 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26111 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26112 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26113 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26115 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26116 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26117 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26118 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26119 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26120 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26121 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26122 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26123 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26124 string as the error text
26126 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26127 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26128 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26132 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26133 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26134 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26135 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26136 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26137 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26138 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26139 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26141 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26142 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26143 configured as follows:
26147 public_name = PLAIN
26149 server_condition = \
26150 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26151 server_set_id = $auth2
26153 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26154 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26155 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26156 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26158 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26159 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26160 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26161 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26165 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26167 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26169 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26170 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26174 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26175 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26177 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26178 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26179 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26180 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26181 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26183 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26184 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26185 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26187 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26188 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26189 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26190 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26191 This is an incorrect example:
26193 server_condition = \
26194 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26196 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26197 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26198 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26199 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26200 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26201 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26202 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26204 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26205 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26207 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26208 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26209 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26210 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26211 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26214 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26215 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26216 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26217 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26218 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26219 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26220 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26224 public_name = LOGIN
26225 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26226 server_condition = \
26227 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26228 server_set_id = $auth1
26230 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26231 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26232 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26233 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26235 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26236 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26237 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26238 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26239 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26243 public_name = LOGIN
26244 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26245 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26248 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26249 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26250 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26251 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26253 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26254 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26255 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26256 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26257 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26258 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26259 uninterpreted string.
26262 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26263 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26264 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26265 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26266 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26272 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26273 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26274 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26276 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26277 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26278 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26279 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26282 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26283 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26284 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26285 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26286 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26287 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26288 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26289 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26290 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26291 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26292 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26293 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26295 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26296 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26298 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26299 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26300 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26301 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26304 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26305 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26309 public_name = PLAIN
26310 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26312 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26313 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26314 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26318 public_name = LOGIN
26319 client_send = : username : mysecret
26321 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26322 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26324 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26325 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26333 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26334 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26335 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26336 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26337 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26338 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26339 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26340 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26341 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26342 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26343 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26344 available in plain text at either end.
26347 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26348 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26349 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26350 authenticator as a server:
26352 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26353 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26354 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26355 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26356 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26357 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26358 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26359 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26360 returned to the client.
26362 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26363 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26364 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26365 numeric variables for other things.
26367 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26368 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26369 user name, authentication fails.
26373 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26374 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26375 server_set_id = $auth1
26377 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26378 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26379 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26380 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26384 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26385 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26387 server_set_id = $auth1
26389 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26390 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26392 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26393 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26394 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26399 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26400 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26401 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26402 server_set_id = $auth1
26405 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26406 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26407 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26411 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26412 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26413 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26416 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26417 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26418 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26422 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26423 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26424 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26425 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26426 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26427 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26428 send the message to the current server.
26430 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26435 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26437 client_secret = secret
26439 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26440 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26445 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26447 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26448 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26449 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26450 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26452 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26453 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26455 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26456 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26457 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26458 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26459 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26461 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26462 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26463 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26464 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26466 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26467 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26468 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26469 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26470 depending on the driver you are using.
26472 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26473 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26474 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26475 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26476 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26479 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26480 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26481 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26482 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26483 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26484 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26485 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26486 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26489 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26490 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26491 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26492 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26493 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26494 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26498 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26499 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26500 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26501 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26504 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26505 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26506 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26507 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26511 driver = cyrus_sasl
26512 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26513 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26514 server_set_id = $auth1
26517 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26518 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26521 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26522 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26525 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26526 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26527 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26528 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26531 driver = cyrus_sasl
26532 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26533 server_set_id = $auth1
26536 driver = cyrus_sasl
26537 public_name = PLAIN
26538 server_set_id = $auth2
26540 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26541 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26542 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26543 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26544 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26551 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26552 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26553 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26554 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26555 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26556 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26557 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26558 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26559 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26561 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26563 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26564 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26565 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26566 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26570 public_name = PLAIN
26571 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26572 server_set_id = $auth1
26577 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26578 server_set_id = $auth1
26580 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26581 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26582 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26583 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26584 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26585 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26586 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26587 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26592 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26593 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26594 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26595 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26596 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26597 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26598 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26599 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26600 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26601 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26602 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26603 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26604 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26605 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26606 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26607 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26608 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26609 without code changes in Exim.
26612 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26613 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26614 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26615 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26616 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26619 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26620 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26621 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26623 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26624 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26625 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26627 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26628 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26629 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26632 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26633 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26634 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26635 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26638 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26639 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26640 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26641 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26646 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26647 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26648 server_set_id = $auth1
26652 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26653 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26654 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26655 the password itself.
26657 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26658 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26659 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26660 if available, else the empty string.
26661 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26662 else the empty string.
26664 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26666 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26667 option to be simply "true".
26670 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26671 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26672 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26675 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26676 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26677 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26678 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26681 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26682 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26683 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26684 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26687 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26688 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26689 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26692 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26693 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26694 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26695 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26697 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26698 meanings for these variables:
26701 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26702 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26704 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26705 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26707 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26708 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26711 On a per-mechanism basis:
26714 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26715 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26716 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26718 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26719 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26720 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26722 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26723 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26724 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26725 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26728 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26729 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26730 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26733 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26734 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26736 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26738 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26739 server_realm = imap.example.org
26740 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26741 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26742 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26743 server_condition = yes
26747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26750 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26751 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26752 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26753 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26754 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26755 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26756 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26759 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26760 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26761 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26762 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26764 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26765 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26766 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26767 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26769 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26770 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26771 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26775 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26776 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26777 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26778 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26780 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26781 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26782 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26783 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26785 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26787 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26788 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26790 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26791 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26792 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26800 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26801 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26802 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26803 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26804 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26805 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26806 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26807 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26808 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26809 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26810 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26811 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26812 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26816 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26817 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26819 The server sends back a challenge.
26821 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26822 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26825 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26829 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26830 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26831 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26833 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26834 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26835 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26836 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26837 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26838 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26839 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26840 for other things. For example:
26845 server_password = \
26846 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26848 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26849 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26855 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26856 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26857 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26861 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26862 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26865 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26866 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26869 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26870 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26871 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26877 client_username = msn/msn_username
26878 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26879 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26881 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26882 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26891 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26892 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26893 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26894 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26895 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26896 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26897 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26898 authentication based on client certificates.
26900 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26901 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26902 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26903 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26904 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26905 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26907 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26908 for which it must have been requested via the
26909 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26910 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26912 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26913 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26914 and can authenticate the connection.
26915 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26917 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26920 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26921 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26923 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26924 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26925 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26926 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26927 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26928 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26930 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26931 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26932 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26934 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26941 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26942 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26943 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26945 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26946 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26947 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26949 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26951 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26952 of your configured trust-anchors
26953 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26954 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26955 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26956 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26958 . An alternative might use
26960 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26962 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26963 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26964 . This would help for per-device use.
26966 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26967 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26969 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26970 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26973 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26974 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26975 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26980 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26982 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26983 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26984 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26985 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26986 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26989 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26990 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26991 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26992 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26993 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26994 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26995 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26996 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26997 certificates are used.
26999 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27000 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27001 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27002 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27003 between them is encrypted.
27005 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27006 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27007 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27008 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27011 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27012 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27013 in order to get TLS to work.
27017 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27019 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27020 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27021 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27022 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27023 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
27024 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
27025 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
27026 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
27027 allocated for this purpose.
27029 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
27030 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
27031 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
27032 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
27034 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27036 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27037 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27038 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27039 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27040 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27043 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27044 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
27051 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27052 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27053 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27054 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27055 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27059 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27063 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27064 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27066 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27069 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27070 cannot be the path of a directory
27071 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27072 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27074 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27076 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27077 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27078 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27079 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27080 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27082 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27083 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27084 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27085 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27086 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27087 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27088 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27091 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27092 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27094 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27095 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27096 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27097 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27099 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27100 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27101 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27102 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27106 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27107 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27108 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27109 but not the chosen filename.
27110 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27111 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27113 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27114 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27115 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27116 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27118 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27119 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27120 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27121 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27122 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27123 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27124 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27126 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27127 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27128 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27129 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27130 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27132 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27133 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27134 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27135 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27136 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27137 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27139 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27140 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27141 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27143 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27144 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27145 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27146 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27149 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27152 # chown exim:exim new-params
27153 # chmod 0600 new-params
27154 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27155 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27156 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27157 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27158 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27159 # chmod 0400 new-params
27160 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27162 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27163 stalling is removed.
27165 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27166 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27167 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27168 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27169 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27170 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27171 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27172 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27173 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27174 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27175 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27177 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27178 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27179 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27180 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27182 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27183 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27184 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27185 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27186 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27189 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27190 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27191 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27192 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27193 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27194 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27195 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27196 directly to this function call.
27197 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27198 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27199 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27200 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27203 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27205 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27206 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27207 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27210 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27211 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27212 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27216 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27219 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27220 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27223 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27224 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27226 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27227 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27230 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27231 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27232 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27233 not be moved to the end of the list.
27236 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27239 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27240 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27243 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27244 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27245 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27246 choice of clients used:
27248 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27249 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27256 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27258 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27259 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27260 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27261 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27262 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27263 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27264 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27265 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27266 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27267 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27269 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27270 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27272 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27273 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27274 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27275 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27276 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27277 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27279 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27280 "Priority strings". This is online as
27281 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27282 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27283 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27284 then the example code
27285 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27286 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27290 # Disable older versions of protocols
27291 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27294 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27295 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27296 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27298 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27299 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27300 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27301 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27305 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27311 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27312 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27313 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27314 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27315 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27316 that STARTTLS is alway advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27317 this is reasonble for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27319 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27320 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27322 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27323 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27324 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27327 554 Security failure
27329 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27330 rejected with a 554 error code.
27332 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27333 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27335 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27336 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27337 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27338 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27340 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27342 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
27343 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
27345 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27346 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27348 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27349 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27350 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27351 that goes with it. These files need to be
27352 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27353 always be given as full path names.
27354 The key must not be password-protected.
27355 They can be the same file if both the
27356 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27357 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27358 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27359 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27360 the server's certificate.
27362 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27363 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27364 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27366 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27367 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27368 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27371 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27372 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27373 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27375 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27377 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27378 with the parameters contained in the file.
27379 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27384 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27385 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27386 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27387 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27393 for a way of generating file data.
27395 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27396 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27397 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27398 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27399 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27401 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27402 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27403 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27404 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27405 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27406 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27407 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27408 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27409 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27411 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27412 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27413 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27414 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27415 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27416 documentation for more details.
27418 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27419 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27422 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27423 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27424 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27425 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27426 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27427 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27428 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27429 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27430 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27431 expected certificates.
27432 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27433 an explicit file or,
27434 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27435 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27437 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27440 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27441 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27442 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27444 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27446 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27448 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27449 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27450 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27451 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27452 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27453 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27454 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27455 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27456 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27457 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27459 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27460 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27461 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27462 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27464 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27465 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27466 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27467 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27468 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27469 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27472 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27473 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27474 .cindex "revocation list"
27475 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27476 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27477 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27478 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27479 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27480 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27481 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27483 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27484 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27486 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27487 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27488 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27489 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27490 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27491 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27493 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27494 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27495 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27496 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27498 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27499 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27500 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27501 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27502 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27503 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27504 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27505 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27507 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27508 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27509 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27511 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27512 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27513 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27514 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27515 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27517 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27518 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27519 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27520 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27521 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27524 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27525 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27528 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27529 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27530 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27531 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27532 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27533 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27535 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27536 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27538 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27541 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27542 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27543 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27545 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27546 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27547 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27553 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27554 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27555 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27556 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27557 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27558 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27559 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27560 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27561 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27563 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27564 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27565 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27566 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27567 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27569 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27570 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27571 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27572 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27573 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27576 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27577 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27578 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27579 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27580 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27581 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27582 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27583 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27584 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27585 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27588 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27589 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27590 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27591 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27593 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27594 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27595 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27597 depending on library version, a directory,
27598 must name a file or,
27599 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27600 The client verifies the server's certificate
27601 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27602 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27603 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27604 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27606 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27607 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27608 or need not succeed respectively.
27610 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27611 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27612 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27614 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27615 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27616 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27619 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27620 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27621 for OCSP to be relevant.
27624 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27625 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27626 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27627 alternative hosts, if any.
27630 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27631 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27632 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27636 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27637 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27638 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27639 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27640 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27642 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27643 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27644 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27645 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27646 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27647 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27648 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27649 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27650 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27651 outgoing connection.
27655 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27656 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27657 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27658 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27659 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27660 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27661 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27662 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27663 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27664 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27667 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27668 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27671 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27672 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27673 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27674 be of limited use in that environment.
27676 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27677 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27678 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27679 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27680 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27682 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27683 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27684 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27685 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27686 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27688 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27689 received from a client.
27690 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27692 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27693 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27694 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27697 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27698 &%tls_certificate%&
27700 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27703 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27706 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27707 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27709 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27713 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27714 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27715 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27716 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27717 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27718 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27719 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27721 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27724 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27725 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27726 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27727 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27729 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27730 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27731 built, then you have SNI support).
27735 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27737 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27738 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27740 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27741 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27742 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27743 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27744 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27745 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27746 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27747 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27749 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27750 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27751 this list the proxy process descibed above is not used; instead Exim
27753 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27754 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27755 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27756 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27758 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27759 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27760 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27761 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27762 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27763 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27764 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27765 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27766 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27768 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27769 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27770 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27771 information is recorded.
27773 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27774 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27775 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27780 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27781 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27782 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27783 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27784 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27785 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27786 to Apache, currently at
27788 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27790 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27791 links to further files.
27792 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27793 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27794 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27796 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27800 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27801 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27802 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27803 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27804 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27805 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27806 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27807 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27808 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27809 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27810 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27811 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27812 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27814 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27815 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27816 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27817 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27821 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27822 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27823 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27824 with OpenSSL, like this:
27825 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27826 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27828 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27831 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27832 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27833 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27834 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27835 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27836 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27837 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27839 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27840 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27841 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27842 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27843 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27844 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27846 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27847 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27848 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27849 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27850 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27851 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27852 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27853 be a sensible resolution).
27855 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27856 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27857 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27859 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27860 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27861 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27862 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27863 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27864 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27866 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27867 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27868 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27869 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27870 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27871 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27876 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27878 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27879 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27880 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27881 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27882 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27883 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27884 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27885 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27886 one very small ACL:
27890 accept hosts = one.host.only
27892 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27893 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27895 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27896 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27897 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27898 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27899 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27900 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27901 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27902 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27905 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27906 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27907 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27910 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27911 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27912 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27913 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27914 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27915 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27916 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27917 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27918 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27919 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27920 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27921 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27922 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27923 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27924 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27925 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27926 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27927 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27928 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27929 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27932 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27933 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27934 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27935 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27936 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27937 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27938 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27939 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27940 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27941 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27942 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27943 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27944 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27945 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27946 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27947 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27948 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27949 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27950 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27951 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27954 For example, if you set
27956 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27958 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27959 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27960 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27961 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27962 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27963 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27964 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27967 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27968 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27969 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27970 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27971 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27972 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27973 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27974 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27975 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27976 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27977 in any of these ACLs.
27979 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27980 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27981 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27982 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27983 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27984 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27985 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27986 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27988 control = suppress_local_fixups
27990 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27991 run, it is too late.
27993 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27994 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27996 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27997 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27998 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28001 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28002 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28003 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28004 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28005 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28006 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28007 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28008 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28009 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28012 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28013 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28014 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28015 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28016 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28017 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28018 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28019 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28020 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28022 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28023 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28024 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28026 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28027 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28028 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28029 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28033 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28034 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28035 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28036 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28037 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28038 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28039 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28040 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28041 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28042 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28044 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28045 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28046 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28047 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28048 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28049 associated with the DATA command.
28051 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28052 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28053 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28054 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28055 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28056 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28057 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28058 the data specified is received.
28060 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28061 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28062 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28063 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28064 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28067 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28068 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28069 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28070 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28072 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28073 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28074 enabled (which is the default).
28076 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28077 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28078 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28080 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28082 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28085 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28086 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28087 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28089 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28092 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28093 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28094 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28095 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28096 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28097 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28098 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28101 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28102 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28103 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28104 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28105 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28106 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28107 for some or all recipients.
28109 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28110 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28111 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28112 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28113 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28115 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28116 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28117 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28119 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28120 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28122 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28123 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28124 the feature was not requested by the client.
28126 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28127 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28128 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28129 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28130 does not in fact control any access.
28131 For this reason, it may only accept
28132 or warn as its final result.
28134 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28135 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28136 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28137 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28139 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28140 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28142 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28143 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28146 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28147 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28148 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28149 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28150 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28153 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28154 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28155 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28156 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28157 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28158 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28159 situation even worse.
28161 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28162 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28163 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28166 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28167 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28168 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28169 connection. The possible values are:
28171 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28172 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28173 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28174 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28175 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28176 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28177 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28178 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28179 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28180 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28182 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28183 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28184 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28185 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28186 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28190 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28191 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28192 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28193 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28195 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28196 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28198 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28199 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
28200 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28201 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28202 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28204 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28205 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28206 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28209 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28210 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28211 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28212 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28213 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28214 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28216 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28217 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28218 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28220 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28221 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28222 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28223 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28225 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28226 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28227 matches the string.
28229 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28230 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28231 want to have something like
28233 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28235 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28236 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28242 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28243 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28244 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28245 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28246 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28247 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28248 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28249 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28250 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28252 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28253 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28254 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28257 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28258 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28259 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28260 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28262 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28263 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28264 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28265 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28266 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28267 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28268 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28270 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28271 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28274 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28275 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28276 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28280 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28281 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28282 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28283 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28284 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28285 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28287 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28288 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28289 used to accept or reject anything.
28291 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28292 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28293 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28294 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28296 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28297 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28298 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28299 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28300 configuration file.
28305 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28306 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28308 .vindex &$local_part$&
28309 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28310 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28311 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28312 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28313 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28314 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28315 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28316 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28317 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28319 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28320 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28321 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28324 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28325 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28326 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28327 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28328 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28331 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28332 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28333 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28334 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28335 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28336 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28337 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28338 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28344 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28345 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28346 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28347 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28348 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28349 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28350 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28351 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28352 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28353 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28354 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28355 unencrypted connections.
28358 accept encrypted = *
28359 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28361 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28363 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28364 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28365 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28366 option to do this.)
28370 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28371 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28372 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28373 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28374 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28375 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28376 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28378 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28379 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28380 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28383 deny dnslists = list1.example
28384 dnslists = list2.example
28386 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28387 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28388 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28389 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28390 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28393 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28394 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28397 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28398 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28399 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28400 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28401 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28402 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28403 check a RCPT command:
28405 accept domains = +local_domains
28409 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28410 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28411 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28412 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28415 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28416 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28417 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28420 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28421 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28422 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28423 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28424 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28425 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28427 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28428 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28430 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28431 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28432 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28434 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28435 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28436 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28441 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28442 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28443 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28444 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28445 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28446 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28447 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28451 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28452 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28453 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28456 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28458 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28462 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28463 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28464 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28465 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28466 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28467 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28468 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28469 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28470 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28472 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28473 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28474 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28478 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28479 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28480 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28482 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28483 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28485 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28486 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28489 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28490 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28491 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28492 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28494 require message = Sender did not verify
28497 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28498 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28499 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28500 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28503 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28504 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28505 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28506 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28507 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28508 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28509 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28511 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28512 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28513 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28514 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28515 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28517 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28518 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28519 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28520 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28521 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28522 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28526 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28527 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28528 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28529 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28531 warn !verify = sender
28532 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28536 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28538 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28539 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28540 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28541 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28542 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28546 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28547 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28548 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28549 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28550 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28551 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28552 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28553 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28554 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28555 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28557 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28558 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28559 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28560 on the same SMTP connection.
28562 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28563 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28564 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28567 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28568 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28569 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28571 accept hosts = whatever
28572 set acl_m4 = some value
28573 accept authenticated = *
28574 set acl_c_auth = yes
28576 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28577 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28578 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28580 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28581 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28582 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28583 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28584 error is generated.
28586 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28587 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28590 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28591 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28592 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28593 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28595 deny domains = *.dom.example
28596 !verify = recipient
28598 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28599 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28600 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28601 two statements are equivalent:
28603 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28604 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28606 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28607 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28609 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28610 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28611 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28613 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28614 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28615 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28616 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28618 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28619 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28620 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28621 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28622 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28623 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28624 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28626 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28627 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28628 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28629 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28630 message is handled.
28632 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28633 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28634 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28635 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28637 require message = Can't verify sender
28639 message = Can't verify recipient
28641 message = This message cannot be used
28643 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28644 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28645 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28646 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28647 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28648 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28650 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28651 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28652 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28653 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28656 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28657 message = Invalid sender from client host
28659 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28660 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28664 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28665 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28666 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28669 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28670 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28671 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28672 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28674 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28675 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28676 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28677 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28678 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28679 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28680 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28681 write rather ugly lines like this:
28683 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28685 Instead, all you need is
28687 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28690 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28691 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28692 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28693 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28694 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28695 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28696 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28697 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28699 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28700 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28701 in several different ways. For example:
28703 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28704 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28705 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28709 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28711 accept ...some conditions
28712 control = queue_only
28714 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28715 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28718 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28720 accept ...some conditions...
28721 control = queue_only
28722 ...some more conditions...
28724 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28725 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28726 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28730 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28731 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28734 warn ...some conditions...
28738 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28739 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28743 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28744 &%require%& verb. For example:
28746 require control = no_multiline_responses
28750 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28751 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28753 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28754 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28755 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28756 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28757 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28758 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28760 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28763 deny ...some conditions...
28766 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28767 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28770 ...some conditions...
28772 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28773 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28775 warn ...some conditions...
28781 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28782 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28783 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28784 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28785 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28786 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28787 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28791 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28792 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28793 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28794 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28795 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28796 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28797 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28800 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28801 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28802 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28803 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28805 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28806 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28808 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28811 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28812 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28814 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28815 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28816 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28819 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28820 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28821 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28822 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28823 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28824 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28827 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28828 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28829 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28832 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28833 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28834 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28835 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28836 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28837 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28839 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28840 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28841 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28842 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28843 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28844 logging rejections.
28847 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28848 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28849 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28850 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28851 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28852 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28853 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28854 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28856 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28857 &` log_reject_target =`&
28859 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28860 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28864 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28865 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28866 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28867 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28868 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28869 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28870 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28873 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28874 &` control = freeze`&
28875 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28877 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28878 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28879 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28882 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28883 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28887 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28888 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28889 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28890 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28891 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28892 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28893 &%accept%& for details.)
28895 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28896 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28897 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28898 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28899 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28901 require message = Host not recognized
28904 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28907 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28908 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28909 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28910 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28911 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28912 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28913 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28914 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28915 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28918 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28919 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28920 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28922 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28923 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28925 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28926 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28927 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28930 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28931 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28933 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28934 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28935 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28938 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28939 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28940 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28942 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28943 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28944 However, the original message is available in the variable
28945 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28946 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28947 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28948 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28950 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28951 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28952 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28953 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28954 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28955 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28959 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28960 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
28962 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
28964 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
28965 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
28966 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
28967 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
28970 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28971 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28972 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28973 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28976 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28977 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28978 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28979 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28982 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28983 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28984 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28985 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28986 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28987 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28988 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28989 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28992 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28993 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29000 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29001 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29002 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29005 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29006 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29007 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29008 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29009 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29010 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29011 not work without it. For example:
29013 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29014 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29016 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29017 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29018 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29019 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29020 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29023 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29024 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29025 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29026 .cindex "case of local parts"
29027 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29028 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29029 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29030 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29031 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29032 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29035 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29036 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29037 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29038 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29039 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29041 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29042 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29045 warn control = caseful_local_part
29046 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29048 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29050 control = caselower_local_part
29052 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29053 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29056 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29057 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29058 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29059 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29061 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29062 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29063 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29064 is used for all recipients of the message,
29065 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29066 and data is copied from one to the other.
29068 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29069 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29070 If a recipient-verify callout
29072 connection is subsequently
29073 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29074 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29075 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29077 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29078 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29079 Note also that headers cannot be
29080 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29081 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29083 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29084 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29085 this will affect the timestamp.
29088 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29089 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29090 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29091 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29094 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29095 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29096 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29097 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29101 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29102 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29103 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29104 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29105 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29107 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29109 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29110 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29111 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29112 and does not queue the message.
29113 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29115 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29117 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29120 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29121 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29122 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29123 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29124 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29125 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29126 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29127 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29128 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29130 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29131 with the &'kill'& option.
29132 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29136 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29137 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29138 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29139 control = debug/kill
29143 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29144 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29145 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29146 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29147 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
29150 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29151 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29152 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29153 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29154 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29155 strings or to numeric value.
29156 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29157 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29158 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29160 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29161 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29162 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29163 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29164 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29167 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29168 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29169 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29170 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29171 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29172 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29173 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29174 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29176 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29177 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29178 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29179 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29180 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29181 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29185 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29186 .cindex "fake defer"
29187 .cindex "defer, fake"
29188 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29189 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29190 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29191 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29192 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29194 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29195 .cindex "fake rejection"
29196 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29197 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29198 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29199 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29200 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29201 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29202 the same SMTP connection.
29204 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29205 message is supplied, the following is used:
29207 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29208 550-kept for evaluation.
29209 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29210 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29212 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29214 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29215 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29216 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29217 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29218 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29219 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29222 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29223 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29224 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29225 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29227 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29228 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29229 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29230 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29231 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29232 disables such output flushing.
29234 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29235 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29236 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29237 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29238 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29239 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29241 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29242 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29243 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29244 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29245 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29246 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29247 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29248 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29249 to be useful in production.
29251 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29252 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29253 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29254 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29255 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29257 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29258 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29259 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29260 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29261 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29262 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29265 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29266 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29267 verification failed"&) is sent.
29269 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29273 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29274 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29276 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29277 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29278 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29279 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29280 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29281 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29282 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29284 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29285 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29286 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29287 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29288 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29289 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29290 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29291 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29292 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29293 same SMTP connection.
29295 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29296 .cindex "message" "submission"
29297 .cindex "submission mode"
29298 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29299 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29300 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29301 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29302 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29303 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29304 late (the message has already been created).
29306 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29307 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29308 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29309 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29310 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29312 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29313 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29314 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29315 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29316 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29319 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29320 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29322 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29324 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29327 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29328 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29329 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29330 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29333 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29334 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29336 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29337 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29339 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29343 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29344 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29347 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29349 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29350 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29352 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29354 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29359 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29360 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29361 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29362 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29363 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29364 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29366 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29367 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29368 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29370 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29371 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29372 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29373 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29374 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29377 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29378 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29380 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29381 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29382 contains one or more newlines that
29383 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29384 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29385 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29387 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29388 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29389 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29390 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29391 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29392 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29393 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29394 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29395 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29396 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29397 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29399 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29400 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29402 until they are added to the
29403 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29404 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29405 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29406 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29407 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29408 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29409 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29411 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29413 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29414 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29416 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29417 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29419 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29420 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29422 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29423 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29424 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29425 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29428 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29429 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29430 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29431 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29432 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29433 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29434 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29437 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29438 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29439 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29440 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29441 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29443 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29444 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29445 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29446 to be a header name first.) For example:
29448 warn add_header = \
29449 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29451 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29452 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29453 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29454 up in reverse order.
29456 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29457 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29458 system filter or in a router or transport.
29462 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29463 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29464 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29465 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29466 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29467 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29469 warn message = Remove internal headers
29470 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29472 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29473 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29474 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29475 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29476 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29477 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29479 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29480 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29482 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29483 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29484 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29485 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29486 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29488 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29489 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29490 warn message = Remove internal headers
29491 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29493 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29494 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29495 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29496 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29497 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29498 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29499 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29500 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29501 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29502 would have been removed.
29504 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29505 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29506 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29507 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29508 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29509 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29510 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29511 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29512 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29514 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29515 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29517 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29518 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29520 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29521 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29523 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29524 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29525 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29526 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29529 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29530 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29531 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29536 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29537 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29538 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29539 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29540 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29541 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29543 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29544 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29545 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29546 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29547 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29548 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29549 The conditions are as follows:
29553 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29554 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29555 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29556 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29557 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29558 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29559 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29560 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29561 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29562 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29563 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29564 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29566 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29567 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29568 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29569 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29570 The name and values are expanded separately.
29571 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29572 will act as argument separators.
29574 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29575 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29576 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29577 conditions are tested.
29579 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29580 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29581 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29582 for different local users or different local domains.
29584 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29585 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29586 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29587 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29588 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29589 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29590 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29595 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29596 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29597 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29598 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29599 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29600 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29601 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29602 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29603 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29604 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29605 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29606 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29609 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29610 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29611 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29612 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29613 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29614 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29615 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29616 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29618 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29619 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29620 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29621 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29622 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29623 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29624 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29625 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29626 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29627 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29629 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29630 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29631 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29632 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29633 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29634 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29635 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29636 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29637 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29640 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29641 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29644 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29645 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29646 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29647 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29648 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29649 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29650 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29656 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29657 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29658 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29659 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29660 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29661 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29662 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29664 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29666 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29667 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29668 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29670 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29671 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29672 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29673 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29674 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29675 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29677 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29678 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29680 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29681 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29683 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29684 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29685 statement can then check the IP address.
29687 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29688 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29689 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29690 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29692 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29693 message = $host_data
29695 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29697 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29698 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29699 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29700 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29701 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29702 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29703 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29704 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29705 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29706 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29708 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29709 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29710 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29711 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29712 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29713 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29714 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29716 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29717 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29718 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29719 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29720 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29721 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29722 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29725 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29726 .cindex "rate limiting"
29727 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29728 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29730 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29731 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29732 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29733 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29734 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29735 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29737 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29738 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29739 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29740 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29741 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29742 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29743 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29745 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29746 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29747 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29748 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29749 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29750 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29751 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29752 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29753 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29754 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29755 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29756 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29757 influence the sender checking.
29759 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29760 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29762 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29763 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29764 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29765 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29766 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29767 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29771 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29772 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29774 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29775 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29776 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29777 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29778 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29779 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29781 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29782 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29783 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29784 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29785 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29786 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29787 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29788 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29789 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29790 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29792 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29793 .cindex "CSA verification"
29794 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29795 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29796 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29798 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29799 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29800 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29801 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29802 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29803 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29804 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29805 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29806 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29807 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29809 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29810 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29811 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29813 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29814 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29815 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29816 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29817 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29818 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29819 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29820 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29821 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29822 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29823 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29824 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29825 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29826 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29827 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29829 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29830 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29831 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29832 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29835 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29836 !verify = header_sender
29839 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29840 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29841 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29842 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29843 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29844 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29845 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29846 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29847 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29848 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29849 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29850 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29851 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29854 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29855 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29859 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29860 common as they used to be.
29862 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29863 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29864 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29865 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29866 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29867 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29868 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29869 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29870 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29871 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29872 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29873 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29874 independently of this condition.
29876 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29877 option), this condition is always true.
29880 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29881 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29882 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29883 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29884 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29885 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29886 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29887 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29888 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29890 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29891 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29894 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29895 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29896 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29897 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29898 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29899 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29900 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29901 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29902 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29903 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29904 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29905 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29906 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29907 value for the child address.
29909 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29910 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29911 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29912 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29913 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29914 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29915 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29916 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29917 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29918 original IP address.
29920 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29921 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29923 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29924 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29926 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29927 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29928 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29929 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29930 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29931 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29932 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29933 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29934 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29936 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29937 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29938 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29939 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29940 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29941 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29942 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29944 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29945 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29946 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29948 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29949 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29950 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29951 verified as a sender.
29953 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
29954 (eg. is generated from the received message)
29955 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
29957 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
29963 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29964 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29965 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29966 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29967 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29968 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29969 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29970 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29971 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29972 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29974 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29975 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29977 the following records are looked up:
29979 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29980 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29982 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29983 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29984 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29985 use two separate conditions:
29987 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29988 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29990 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29991 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29992 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29995 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29996 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29997 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29998 following special items in the list:
30000 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30001 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30002 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30004 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30005 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30006 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30007 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30009 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30011 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30012 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30014 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30015 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30016 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30018 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30020 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30021 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30022 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30023 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30024 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30025 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30029 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30030 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30031 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30032 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30033 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30035 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30037 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30038 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30039 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30040 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30045 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30046 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30047 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30048 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30049 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30050 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30051 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30053 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30054 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30056 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30057 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30058 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30059 up by this example is
30061 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30063 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30064 addresses. For example:
30066 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30067 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30069 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30070 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30075 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30076 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30077 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30078 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30079 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30080 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30081 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30082 either to double the separators like this:
30084 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30086 or to change the separator character, like this:
30088 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30090 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30091 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30092 occurs. Consider this condition:
30094 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30096 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30098 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30099 a.domain.black.list.tld
30101 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30102 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30103 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30104 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30105 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30106 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30107 error for a previous item.
30109 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30110 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30112 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30113 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30115 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30116 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30118 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30119 $sender_address_domain \
30120 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30122 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30123 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30124 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30126 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30127 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30128 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30129 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30131 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30133 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30134 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30136 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30137 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30142 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30143 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30144 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30145 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30146 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30147 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30151 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30153 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30154 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30155 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30157 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30158 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30159 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30162 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30163 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30164 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30165 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30166 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30167 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30168 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30169 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30170 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30171 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30172 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30173 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30174 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30175 cases, for example:
30177 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30179 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30180 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30181 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30182 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30184 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30186 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30187 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30189 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30190 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30191 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30192 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30193 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30196 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30197 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30198 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30200 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30201 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30203 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30208 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30209 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30210 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30211 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30214 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30216 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30217 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30218 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30219 describes how multiple records are handled.
30221 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30222 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30223 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30225 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30227 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30228 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30229 first. For example:
30231 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30232 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30235 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30236 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30237 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30238 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30239 tested. For example:
30241 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30243 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30244 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30245 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30247 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30249 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30254 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30255 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30258 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30260 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30261 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30263 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30265 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30266 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30267 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30268 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30270 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30271 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30273 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30274 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30276 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30277 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30279 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30280 Consider this example:
30282 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30284 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30287 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30289 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30291 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30292 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30293 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30295 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30300 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30301 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30302 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30303 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30304 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30305 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30307 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30309 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30310 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30311 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30312 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30313 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30314 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30317 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30318 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30319 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30321 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30322 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30325 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30327 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30328 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30330 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30332 for the condition to be true.
30335 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30336 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30338 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30339 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30341 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30343 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30344 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30346 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30347 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30349 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30351 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30352 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30354 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30356 for the condition to be false.
30358 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30359 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30364 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30365 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30366 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30367 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30368 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30369 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30370 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30371 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30372 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30375 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30376 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30377 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30378 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30379 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30380 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30381 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30384 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30385 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30387 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30388 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30390 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30391 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30392 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30393 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30394 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30395 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30397 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30398 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30399 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30401 reject dnslists = \
30402 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30403 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30404 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30405 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30407 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30408 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30409 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30413 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30414 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30415 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30416 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30417 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30418 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30420 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30421 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30423 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30424 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30425 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30427 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30429 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30430 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30432 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30433 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30435 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30436 dnslists = some.list.example
30439 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30440 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30441 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30443 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30446 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30447 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30448 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30449 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30450 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30451 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30452 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30453 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30454 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30455 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30457 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30459 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30460 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30462 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30463 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30464 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30467 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30468 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30469 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30470 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30471 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30472 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30473 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30474 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30475 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30477 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30478 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30479 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30480 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30482 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30483 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30484 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30485 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30486 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30487 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30488 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30489 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30490 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30491 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30493 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30494 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30495 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30498 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30499 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30500 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30501 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30502 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30503 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30505 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30506 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30507 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30508 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30509 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30510 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30511 the &%count=%& option.
30514 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30515 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30516 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30517 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30518 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30520 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30521 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30522 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30523 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30525 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30526 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30527 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30528 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30529 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30530 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30531 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30533 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30534 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30535 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30536 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30537 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30538 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30539 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30541 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30542 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30543 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30544 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30547 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30548 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30549 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30550 multiple different commands.
30552 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30553 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30554 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30555 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30556 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30558 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30561 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30562 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30563 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30564 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30565 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30567 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30568 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30570 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30571 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30572 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30573 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30577 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30578 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30579 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30582 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30583 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30584 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30587 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30588 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30589 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30590 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30591 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30592 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30595 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30596 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30597 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30598 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30599 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30602 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30603 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30604 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30605 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30606 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30607 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30610 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30611 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30612 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30613 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30614 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30615 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30616 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30617 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30618 from getting any email through.
30620 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30621 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30622 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30623 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30624 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30625 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30626 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30627 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30629 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30633 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30634 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30635 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30636 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30637 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30638 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30639 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30640 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30641 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30643 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30644 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30645 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30646 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30647 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30648 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30650 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30651 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30654 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30655 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30656 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30657 required increases with larger limits.
30659 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30660 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30661 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30662 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30663 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30664 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30665 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30666 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30667 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30671 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30672 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30673 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30674 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30675 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30676 message. For example:
30678 # Log all senders' rates
30679 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30680 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30682 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30683 # at the decimal point.
30684 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30685 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30686 $sender_rate_limit }s
30688 # Keep authenticated users under control
30689 deny authenticated = *
30690 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30692 # System-wide rate limit
30693 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30694 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30696 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30697 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30698 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30699 messages per $sender_rate_period
30700 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30701 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30702 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30704 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30705 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30706 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30707 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30708 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30709 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30710 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30714 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30715 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30716 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30717 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30718 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30719 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30720 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30721 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30722 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30724 verify = sender/callout
30725 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30727 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30728 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30729 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30730 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30731 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30732 The available options are as follows:
30735 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30736 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30737 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30739 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30740 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30741 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30742 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30744 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30745 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30747 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30748 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30749 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30750 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30753 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30754 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30755 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30756 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30757 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30758 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30761 warn !verify = sender
30762 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30764 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30765 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30766 verification failure.
30768 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30769 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30772 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30773 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30775 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30777 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30778 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30779 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30781 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30783 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30786 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30787 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30792 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30793 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30794 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30795 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30796 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30797 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30798 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30799 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30800 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30801 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30802 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30803 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30806 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30807 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30808 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30809 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30810 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30811 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30813 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30814 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30815 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30816 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30817 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30819 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30820 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30821 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30822 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30823 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30824 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30825 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30826 supplies a host list.
30827 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30829 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30830 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30831 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30832 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30833 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30834 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30835 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30837 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30838 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30839 following SMTP commands are sent:
30841 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30843 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30846 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30849 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30852 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30853 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30854 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30855 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30856 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30857 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30859 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30860 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30861 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30862 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30863 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30865 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30866 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30867 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30868 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30869 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30874 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30875 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30876 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30877 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30879 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30881 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30882 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30883 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30887 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30888 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30889 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30892 verify = sender/callout=5s
30894 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30895 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30896 the &%connect%& parameter.
30899 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30900 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30901 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30902 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30904 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30906 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30908 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30909 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30910 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30911 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30912 updated in this circumstance.
30914 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30915 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30916 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30917 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30918 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30919 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30922 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30923 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30924 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30925 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30926 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30927 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30928 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30929 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30930 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30931 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30933 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30935 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30938 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30939 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30940 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30943 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30945 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30946 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30947 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30948 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30949 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30952 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30953 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30954 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30955 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30957 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30958 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30959 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30960 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30961 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30962 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30963 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30964 made, until the cache record expires.
30966 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30967 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30968 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30971 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30973 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30974 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30976 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30978 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30979 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30980 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30981 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30985 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30986 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30987 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30988 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30989 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30991 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30993 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30994 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30995 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30996 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30997 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30999 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31000 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31001 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31003 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31005 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31006 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31007 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31008 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31009 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31011 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31012 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31014 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31016 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31017 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31018 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31019 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31020 usefulness of callout caching.
31024 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31026 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31028 It causes the connection to be helod open and used for any further recipients
31029 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31030 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31031 when that is used for the connections.
31032 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31033 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31034 if the use_sender option is used,
31035 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31036 and if no other callouts intervene.
31040 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31041 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31042 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31043 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31044 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31045 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31046 these circumstances.
31048 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31049 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31050 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31051 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31052 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31053 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31054 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31056 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31057 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31058 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31059 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31064 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31065 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31066 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31067 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31068 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31069 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31070 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31071 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31072 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31073 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31075 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31076 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31079 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31080 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31081 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31083 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31084 commands up to and including
31088 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31089 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31090 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31091 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31092 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31093 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31094 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31096 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31097 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31098 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31099 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31100 will eventually be noticed.
31102 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31103 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31104 behaviour will be the same.
31108 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31109 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31110 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31111 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31112 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31113 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31116 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31118 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31119 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31120 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31121 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31122 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31123 550 Sender verification failed
31125 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31126 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31127 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31128 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31131 verify = sender/no_details
31134 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31135 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31136 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31137 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31138 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31139 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31140 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31143 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31144 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31145 verification also fails.
31147 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31148 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31151 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31152 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31153 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31156 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31158 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31159 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31160 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31161 verification to succeed.
31163 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31164 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31165 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31166 option. For example:
31168 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31170 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31171 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31173 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31174 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31175 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31176 address and a report is output for each of them.
31180 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31181 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31182 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31183 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31184 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31185 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31186 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31190 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31191 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31192 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31193 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31194 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31195 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31197 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31198 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31199 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31200 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31203 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31205 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31207 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31208 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31210 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31211 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31214 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31215 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31217 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31219 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31220 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31221 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31222 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31225 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31227 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31228 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31229 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31231 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31232 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31233 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31234 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31235 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31236 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31237 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31238 of legitimate HELO domains.
31240 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31241 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31242 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31243 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31246 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31248 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31249 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31250 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31255 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31256 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31257 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31258 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31259 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31260 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31261 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31262 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31264 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31265 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31266 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31267 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31268 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31269 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31270 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31272 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31273 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31276 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31277 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31280 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31281 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31284 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31285 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31287 recipients = +batv_senders
31289 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31290 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31292 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31293 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31294 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31296 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31297 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31298 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31299 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31300 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31302 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31303 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31304 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31305 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31306 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31307 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31308 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31310 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31311 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31312 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31313 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31317 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31319 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31320 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31321 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31324 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31327 external_smtp_batv:
31329 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31330 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31331 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31332 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31335 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31339 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31340 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31341 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31342 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31343 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31344 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31345 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31346 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31347 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31348 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31350 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31351 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31352 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31353 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31354 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31355 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31357 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31359 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31360 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31361 system to arbitrary domains.
31364 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31365 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31366 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31367 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31370 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31371 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31372 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31374 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31375 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31377 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31378 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31382 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31384 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31385 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31386 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31388 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31392 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31393 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31395 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31396 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31397 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31398 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31399 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31400 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31401 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31405 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31406 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31407 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31408 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31409 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31414 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31417 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31418 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31419 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31420 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31421 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31422 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31425 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31426 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31427 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31428 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31429 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31431 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31432 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31433 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31436 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31437 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31439 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31440 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31441 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31443 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31444 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31446 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31449 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31452 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31453 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31454 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31455 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31456 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31457 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31459 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31460 temporarily created in a file called:
31462 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31464 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31465 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31466 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31467 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31468 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31470 control = no_mbox_unspool
31472 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31473 same directory by default.
31477 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31478 .cindex "virus scanning"
31479 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31480 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31481 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31482 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31483 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31484 in memory and thus are much faster.
31486 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31487 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31489 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31490 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31491 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31492 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31494 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31496 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31498 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31500 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31502 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31503 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31507 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31508 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31509 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31510 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31511 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31512 This scanner type takes one option,
31513 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31514 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31515 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31516 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31517 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31518 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31521 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31522 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31524 If you omit the argument, the default path
31525 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31527 If you use a remote host,
31528 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31529 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31530 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31532 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31539 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31540 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31541 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31542 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31543 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31546 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31551 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31552 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31553 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31554 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31555 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31557 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31558 a UNIX socket specification,
31559 a TCP socket specification,
31560 or a (global) option.
31562 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31563 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31564 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31565 and the second a port number,
31566 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31567 These per-server options are supported:
31569 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31572 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31573 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31575 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31579 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31580 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31581 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31582 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31583 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31585 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31587 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31588 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31589 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31590 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31591 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31592 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31594 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31595 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31596 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31597 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31598 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31599 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31600 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31601 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31602 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31604 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31605 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31606 (Connection refused)
31609 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31610 contributing the code for this scanner.
31613 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31614 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31615 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31616 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31619 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31620 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31623 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31624 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31625 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31626 the &"trigger"& expression.
31629 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31630 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31631 &"name"& expression.
31634 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31636 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31638 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31639 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31640 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31641 configuration setting:
31643 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31644 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31645 found in file:'(.+)'
31648 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31649 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31651 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31652 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31653 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31654 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31657 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31658 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31660 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31661 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31664 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31665 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31666 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31670 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31672 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31675 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31676 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31677 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31678 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31681 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31683 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31687 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31688 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31689 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31691 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31693 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31694 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31696 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31697 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31698 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31699 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31700 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31703 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31705 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31708 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31709 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31710 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31711 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31712 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31713 provided that mksd has
31714 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31716 av_scanner = mksd:2
31718 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31721 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31722 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31723 running on the local machine.
31724 There are four options:
31725 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31726 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31727 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31728 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31729 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31732 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
31735 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
31736 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
31737 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
31738 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
31739 specify an empty element to get this.
31743 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31744 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31745 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31746 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31747 client communication. For example:
31749 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31751 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31755 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31756 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31759 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31760 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31761 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31762 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31763 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31764 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31767 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31768 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31769 The first element can then be one of
31772 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31773 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31776 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31777 the condition fails immediately.
31779 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31780 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31781 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31782 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31783 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31786 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31787 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31788 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31790 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31791 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31794 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31796 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31798 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31799 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31800 is set to record the actual address used.
31802 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31803 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31804 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31805 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31808 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31809 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31811 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31813 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31816 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31818 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31819 malware = */defer_ok
31821 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31822 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31824 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31826 in the main Exim configuration.
31828 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31829 set acl_m0 = sophie
31832 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31833 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31838 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31839 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31840 .cindex "spam scanning"
31841 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31843 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31844 score and a report for the message.
31845 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31847 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31848 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31849 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31851 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31853 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31855 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31856 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31859 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31860 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31861 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31862 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31863 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31864 configuration as follows (example):
31866 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31868 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
31869 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
31870 iptables firewall, consider setting
31871 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
31872 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
31873 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
31874 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
31878 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31880 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31882 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31885 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31886 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31887 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31889 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31891 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31892 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31893 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31894 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31896 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31897 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31900 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31901 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31902 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31905 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31906 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31907 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
31909 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31910 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31911 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31912 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31914 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31916 The supported options are:
31918 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31919 weight=<value> Selection bias
31920 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31921 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31922 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31923 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31926 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31927 higher values being tried first.
31928 The default priority is 1.
31930 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31931 Within a priority set
31932 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31933 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31935 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31936 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31937 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31938 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31940 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31941 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31943 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31944 The default value is two minutes.
31946 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31947 a failed connect is made.
31948 The default is to not retry.
31950 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31951 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31952 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31955 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31956 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31957 is set to record the actual address used.
31959 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31960 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31962 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31965 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31966 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31967 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31968 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31969 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31972 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31973 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31974 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31975 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31976 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31978 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31979 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31981 or the use of PRDR,
31982 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31983 are needed to use this feature.
31985 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31986 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31987 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31990 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31991 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31992 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31995 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31996 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32000 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32001 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32002 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32003 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32005 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32006 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32008 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32009 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32010 available for use at delivery time.
32013 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32014 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32015 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32017 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32018 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32019 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32020 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32021 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32023 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32024 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32025 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32026 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32027 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32028 spam bar is 50 characters.
32030 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32031 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32032 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32033 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32034 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32035 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32036 unencoded in headers.
32038 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32039 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32040 spam score versus threshold.
32041 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32045 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32046 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32047 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32049 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32050 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32051 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32052 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32053 spam condition, like this:
32055 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32056 spam = joe/defer_ok
32058 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32060 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32063 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32064 warn spam = nobody:true
32065 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32066 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32068 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32069 # is over threshold
32071 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32073 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32074 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32076 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32081 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32082 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32083 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32084 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32085 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32086 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32087 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32088 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32089 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32090 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32093 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32094 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32095 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32096 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32097 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32098 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32099 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32101 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32102 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32103 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32104 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32105 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32107 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32108 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32109 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32110 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32111 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32114 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32116 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32120 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32122 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32123 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32124 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32125 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32127 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32128 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32129 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32130 the full path and file name.
32132 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32133 filename, and the default path is then used.
32135 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32136 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32137 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32139 decode = $mime_filename
32141 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32142 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32143 automatically unlinked.
32145 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32146 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32147 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32148 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32149 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32151 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32152 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32153 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32155 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32156 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32157 available in the MIME ACL:
32160 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32161 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32162 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32163 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32164 contains the empty string.
32166 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32167 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32168 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32174 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32175 case-insensitively.
32177 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32178 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32179 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32180 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32181 only used for display purposes.
32183 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32184 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32185 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32187 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32188 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32189 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32191 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32192 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32193 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32194 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32195 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32197 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32198 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32199 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32200 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32202 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32203 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32204 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32205 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32209 application/octet-stream
32213 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32216 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32217 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32218 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32219 containing the decoded data.
32224 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32225 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32226 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32227 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32230 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32232 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32234 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32235 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32236 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32237 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32239 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32240 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32244 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32247 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32248 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32251 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32252 and the rest are attachments.
32255 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32258 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32259 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32260 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32262 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32263 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32264 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32265 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32267 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32268 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32269 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32270 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32271 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32273 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32274 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32275 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32276 decoding is fully recursive.
32278 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32279 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32280 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32281 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32282 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32283 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32284 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32289 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32290 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32291 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32292 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32293 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32295 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32296 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32297 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32298 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32299 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32301 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32302 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32303 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32304 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32305 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32306 32K characters are checked.
32308 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32309 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32310 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32311 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32312 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32314 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32315 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32317 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32318 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32319 matching regular expression.
32320 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32321 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32323 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32334 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32335 "Local scan function"
32336 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32337 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32338 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32339 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32340 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32342 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32343 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32344 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32345 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32346 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32348 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32349 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32350 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32351 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32353 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32354 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32355 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32356 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32358 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32359 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32360 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32361 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32362 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32363 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32364 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32365 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32366 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32370 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32371 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32372 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32373 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32374 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32375 directory, so you might set
32377 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32379 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32380 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32381 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32382 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32383 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32384 _src/local_scan.c_.
32386 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32387 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32389 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32391 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32396 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32397 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32398 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32400 #include "local_scan.h"
32402 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32403 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32404 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32405 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32406 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32407 strings and pointers to character strings:
32409 #define CS (char *)
32410 #define CCS (const char *)
32411 #define CSS (char **)
32412 #define US (unsigned char *)
32413 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32414 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32416 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32418 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32420 The arguments are as follows:
32423 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32424 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32425 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32427 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32428 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32429 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32430 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32431 case this changes in some future version.
32433 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32434 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32437 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32440 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32441 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32442 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32443 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32444 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32445 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32447 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32448 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32449 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32451 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32452 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32453 queued without immediate delivery.
32455 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32456 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32457 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32458 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32459 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32462 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32463 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32464 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32467 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32468 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32469 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32470 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32471 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32472 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32473 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32475 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32476 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32477 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32480 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32481 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32482 &%-oe%& command line options.
32486 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32487 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32488 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32489 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32490 want to do this, you must have the line
32492 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32494 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32495 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32496 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32499 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32500 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32501 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32502 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32503 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32504 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32506 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32507 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32509 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32510 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32511 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32514 int local_scan_options_count =
32515 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32517 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32518 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32522 my_string = some string of text...
32524 The available types of option data are as follows:
32527 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32528 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32529 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32530 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32531 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32532 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32535 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32536 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32537 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32538 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32541 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32542 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32545 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32546 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32547 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32548 printed with the suffix K or M.
32550 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32551 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32552 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32553 always output in octal.
32555 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32556 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32557 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32559 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32560 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32561 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32564 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32565 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32569 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32570 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32571 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32572 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32573 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32574 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32575 C variables are as follows:
32578 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32579 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32581 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32584 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32585 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32587 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32590 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32591 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32592 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32593 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32596 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32597 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32598 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32601 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32602 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32606 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32607 selected, you should use code like this:
32609 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32610 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32612 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32613 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32614 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32616 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32617 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32620 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32621 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32623 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32624 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32626 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32627 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32628 &%-bh%& command line option.
32630 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32631 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32632 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32634 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32635 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32636 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32637 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32639 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32640 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32641 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32643 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32644 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32646 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32647 The number of accepted recipients.
32649 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32650 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32651 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32652 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32653 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32654 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32655 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32656 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32657 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32658 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32659 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32660 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32662 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32663 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32665 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32666 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32667 locally-submitted messages.
32669 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32670 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32671 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32673 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32674 The name of the sending host, if known.
32676 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32677 The port on the sending host.
32679 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32680 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32682 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32683 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32685 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32686 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32687 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32691 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32692 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32693 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32694 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32699 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32700 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32702 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32703 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32704 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32705 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32706 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32707 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32708 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32710 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32711 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32714 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32715 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32716 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32721 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32722 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32725 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32726 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32728 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32729 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32730 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32731 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32733 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32734 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32735 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32736 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32737 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32738 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32739 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32740 is NULL for all recipients.
32745 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32746 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32747 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32748 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32752 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32753 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32755 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32756 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32757 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32758 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32760 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32761 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32762 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32763 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32764 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32766 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32768 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32769 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32770 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32771 return value is as follows:
32776 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32782 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32788 The process timed out.
32792 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32795 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32796 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32797 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32798 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32799 forks a subprocess that is running
32801 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32803 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32804 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32805 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32806 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32808 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32809 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32810 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32811 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32814 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32815 *sender_authentication)*&
32816 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32819 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32821 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32824 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32825 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32826 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32827 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32828 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32830 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32831 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32834 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32835 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32836 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32837 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32838 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32839 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32840 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32841 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32843 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32844 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32845 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32846 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32847 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32848 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32850 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32851 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32852 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32853 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32855 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32856 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32857 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32858 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32859 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32860 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32861 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32862 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32863 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32864 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32866 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32867 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32869 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32870 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32873 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32874 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32875 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32876 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32877 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32880 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32881 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32882 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32883 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32884 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32885 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32887 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32889 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32890 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32891 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32892 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32893 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32896 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32897 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32898 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32899 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32900 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32901 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32902 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32903 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32905 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32906 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32907 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32909 &`OK `& match succeeded
32910 &`FAIL `& match failed
32911 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32913 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32914 inability to contact a database.
32916 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32918 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32919 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32920 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32922 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32924 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32925 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32926 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32928 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32930 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32933 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32935 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32936 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32937 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32938 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32939 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32940 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32943 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32945 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32946 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32947 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32948 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32949 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32950 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32953 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32954 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32955 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32956 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32958 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32959 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32960 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32961 value afterwards. For example:
32963 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32964 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32965 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32968 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32969 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32970 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32971 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32978 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32979 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32980 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32981 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32982 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32983 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32984 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32985 binary string is returned with an error message.
32987 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32988 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32989 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32991 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32992 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32993 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32994 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32995 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32997 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32998 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32999 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33001 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33002 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33003 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33004 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33008 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33009 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33012 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33013 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33014 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33015 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33016 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33017 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33018 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33019 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33022 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33023 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33025 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33026 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33027 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33028 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33029 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33030 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33031 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33033 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33034 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33036 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33037 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33038 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33039 multiple output lines.
33041 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33042 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33043 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33044 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33045 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33046 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33047 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33050 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33051 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33052 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33053 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33055 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33056 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33057 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33059 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33062 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33065 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33066 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33067 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33068 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33069 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33070 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33076 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33077 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33078 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33079 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33080 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33081 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33082 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33085 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33086 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33087 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33088 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33090 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33091 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33093 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33095 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33096 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33097 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33098 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33100 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33101 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33102 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33103 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33113 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33114 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33115 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33116 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33117 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33118 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33119 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33120 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33122 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33123 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33124 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33125 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33126 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33128 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33129 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33130 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33131 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33132 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33133 prevent it happening on retries.
33135 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33136 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33137 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33138 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33139 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33140 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33141 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33142 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33145 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33146 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33147 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33148 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33149 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33150 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33151 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33153 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33154 system_filter_user = exim
33156 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33157 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33158 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33159 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33160 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33161 by the &%reply%& command.
33164 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33165 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33166 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33167 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33169 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33170 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33174 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33175 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33176 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33177 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33178 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33179 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33182 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33183 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33184 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33185 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33186 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33187 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33188 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33190 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33191 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33192 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33193 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33194 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33196 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33197 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33198 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33199 to which users' filter files can refer.
33203 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33204 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33205 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33206 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33207 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33211 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33212 .cindex "freezing messages"
33213 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33214 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33215 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33216 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33217 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33218 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33219 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33220 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33221 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33222 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33224 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33226 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33228 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33229 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33230 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33231 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33232 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33235 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33236 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33237 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33238 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33240 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33241 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33242 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33243 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33244 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33245 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33246 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33247 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33248 message. For example:
33250 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33251 because it contains attachments that we are \
33252 not prepared to receive."
33255 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33256 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33257 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33258 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33259 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33260 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33263 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33264 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33266 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33267 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33268 generated by the filter.
33270 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33272 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33273 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33279 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33280 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33285 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33286 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33287 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33288 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33289 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33291 headers add <string>
33292 headers remove <string>
33294 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33295 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33296 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33297 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33298 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33300 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33301 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33302 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33305 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33306 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33309 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33310 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33311 space after input continuations is ignored.
33313 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33314 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33315 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33316 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33317 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33319 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33320 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33321 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33322 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33323 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33324 used for all recipients of the message.
33326 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33327 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33328 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33329 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33330 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33331 until the message is actually being written (see section
33332 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33334 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33335 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33336 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33337 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33338 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33339 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33340 modified more than once.
33342 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33343 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33346 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33347 headers remove "Subject"
33348 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33349 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33354 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33355 .cindex "envelope sender"
33356 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33358 errors_to <some address>
33360 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33361 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33362 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33365 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33367 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33368 address if its delivery failed.
33372 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33373 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33374 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33375 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33376 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33377 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33378 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33379 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33380 which implements such a filter:
33385 domains = +local_domains
33386 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33391 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33392 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33393 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33394 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33396 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33397 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33398 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33399 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33401 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33402 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33403 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33410 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33411 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33413 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33414 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33415 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33416 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33417 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33418 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33419 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33420 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33422 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33423 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33424 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33425 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33426 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33428 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33429 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33430 loopback interface specially in any way.
33432 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33433 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33438 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33439 .cindex "message" "submission"
33440 .cindex "submission mode"
33441 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33442 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33443 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33444 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33446 control = submission
33448 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33449 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33450 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33451 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33452 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33453 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33455 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33456 control = submission
33458 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33459 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33460 is used to separate options. For example:
33462 control = submission/sender_retain
33464 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33465 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33466 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33467 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33468 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33469 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33470 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33472 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33473 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33476 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33478 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33479 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33480 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33481 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33483 accept authenticated = *
33484 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33485 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33486 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33488 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33489 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33490 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33492 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33494 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33497 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33499 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33500 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33501 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33502 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33504 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33505 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33506 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33507 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33508 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33509 spoof another's address.
33511 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33512 .cindex "line endings"
33513 .cindex "carriage return"
33515 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33516 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33517 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33518 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33519 use CRLF or just CR.
33521 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33522 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33523 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33524 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33525 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33526 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33527 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33528 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33532 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33534 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33537 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33538 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33541 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33542 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33543 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33544 people trying to play silly games.
33546 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33547 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33555 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33556 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33557 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33558 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33559 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33560 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33561 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33562 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33564 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33565 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33566 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33567 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33568 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33570 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33571 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33572 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33573 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33574 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33575 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33576 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33577 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33582 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33583 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33584 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33585 .cindex "sender" "address"
33586 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33587 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33588 .cindex "envelope sender"
33589 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33590 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33591 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33592 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33594 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33595 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33597 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33598 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33599 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33600 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33601 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33602 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33603 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33604 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33605 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33607 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33608 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33609 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33610 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33611 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33612 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33613 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33615 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33616 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33617 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33619 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33620 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33621 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33622 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33626 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33627 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33628 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33629 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33630 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33631 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33632 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33633 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33636 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33637 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33640 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33641 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33645 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33646 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33648 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33649 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33650 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33652 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33655 For a locally-submitted message,
33656 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33657 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33658 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33659 included in log lines in this case.
33661 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33662 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33668 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33669 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33670 includes the header line:
33672 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33675 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33676 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33677 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33678 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33679 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33680 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33683 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33684 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33685 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33686 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33687 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33688 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33690 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33691 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33692 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33693 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33694 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33695 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33696 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33697 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33701 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33702 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33703 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
33704 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33705 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33706 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33707 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33708 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33709 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33713 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33714 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33715 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
33716 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33717 .cindex "message" "submission"
33718 .cindex "submission mode"
33719 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33720 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33723 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33724 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33726 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33727 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33729 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33730 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33731 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33733 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33734 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33736 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33737 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33741 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33743 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33744 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33745 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33746 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33747 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33748 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33749 &%qualify_domain%&.
33751 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33752 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33753 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33754 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33757 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33758 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33759 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
33760 .cindex "message" "submission"
33761 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33762 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33763 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33764 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33765 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33766 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33767 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33768 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33769 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33770 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33773 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33774 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33775 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
33776 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33777 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33778 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33780 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33781 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33782 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33783 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33785 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33786 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33787 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33790 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33791 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33792 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
33793 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33794 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33795 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33796 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33797 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33798 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33799 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33800 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33801 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33805 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33806 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33807 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
33808 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33809 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33810 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33811 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33812 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33813 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33817 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33818 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33819 .cindex "message" "submission"
33820 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
33821 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33822 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33823 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33824 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33827 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33828 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33829 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33830 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33831 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33832 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33833 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33834 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33835 line is added to the message.
33837 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33838 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33839 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33840 options true at the same time.
33842 .cindex "submission mode"
33843 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33844 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33845 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33846 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33848 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33849 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33850 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33851 created as follows:
33854 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33855 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33856 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33858 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33859 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33861 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33862 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33865 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33866 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33867 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33868 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33870 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33871 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33872 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33873 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33877 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33878 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33879 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33880 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33881 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33882 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33883 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33884 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33885 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33887 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33888 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33889 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33890 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33891 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33892 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33894 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33895 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33896 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33898 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33899 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33900 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33902 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33903 X-added-second: another added header line
33905 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33907 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33908 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33909 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33911 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33912 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33913 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33914 not part of the names. For example:
33916 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33919 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33920 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33921 Each item is separately expanded.
33922 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33923 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33924 will act as list separators.
33926 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33927 items are expanded at routing time,
33928 and then associated with all addresses that are
33929 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33930 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33931 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33933 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33934 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33935 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33936 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33938 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33939 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33940 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33943 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33944 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33945 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33946 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33947 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33948 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33949 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33951 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33952 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33953 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33954 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33956 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33957 the following consequences:
33960 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33961 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33962 to it, at all times.
33964 Header lines that are added by a router's
33965 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33966 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33968 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33969 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33971 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33972 a later router or by a transport.
33974 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33975 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33977 headers_remove = subject
33978 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33982 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33983 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33989 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33990 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33991 .cindex "constructed address"
33992 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33995 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33999 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34001 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34002 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34003 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34004 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34005 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34006 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34007 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34008 there is no password file entry.
34011 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34012 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34013 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34014 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34015 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34016 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34017 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34018 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34022 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34023 .cindex "case of local parts"
34024 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34025 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34026 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34027 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34028 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34029 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34030 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34033 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34034 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34035 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34036 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34037 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34041 domains = +local_domains
34042 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34043 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34046 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34047 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34048 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34049 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34050 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34054 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34055 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34056 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34057 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34058 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34059 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34060 empty components for compatibility.
34064 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34065 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34066 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34067 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34068 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34069 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34071 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34072 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34073 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34074 example, a header such as
34078 might get rewritten as
34080 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34082 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34083 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34086 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34087 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34088 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34089 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34090 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34091 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34092 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34099 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34100 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34101 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34102 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34103 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34104 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34105 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34108 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34110 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34112 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34115 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34118 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34120 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34123 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34126 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34127 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34130 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34131 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34132 used to contain the envelope information.
34136 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34137 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34138 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34139 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34140 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34143 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34144 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34145 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34146 processing is the same in both cases.
34148 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34149 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34150 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34151 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34152 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34153 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34154 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34155 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34158 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34159 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34160 required for the transaction.
34162 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34163 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34164 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34165 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34166 is called for verification.
34168 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34169 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34170 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34172 .cindex "carriage return"
34174 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34175 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34176 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34179 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34180 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34181 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34182 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34183 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34184 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34185 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34186 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34187 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34189 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34190 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34191 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34192 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34194 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34195 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34196 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34197 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34199 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34200 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34201 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34202 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34203 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34204 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34205 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34206 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34207 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34208 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34210 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34211 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34213 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34214 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34215 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34216 square bracket of the IP address.
34221 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34222 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34223 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34224 .cindex "host" "error"
34225 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34226 message errors, and recipient errors.
34229 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34230 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34231 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34234 Connection refused or timed out,
34236 Any error response code on connection,
34238 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34240 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34242 I/O errors at any time,
34244 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34245 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34248 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34249 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34250 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34251 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34252 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34253 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34254 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34255 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34257 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34258 .cindex "message" "error"
34259 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34260 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34261 message errors are:
34264 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34267 Timeout after MAIL,
34269 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34270 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34271 connection at any other time.
34274 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34275 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34276 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34277 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34278 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34279 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34280 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34281 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34282 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34283 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34285 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34286 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34287 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34290 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34291 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34292 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34293 recipient errors are:
34296 Any error response to RCPT,
34298 Timeout after RCPT.
34301 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34302 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34303 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34304 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34305 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34306 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34307 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34308 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34309 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34310 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34311 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34312 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34313 the retry clock is reset.
34315 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34316 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34317 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34318 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34319 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34320 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34321 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34322 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34323 recipient's retry time.
34326 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34327 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34328 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34329 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34330 until the next delivery attempt.
34332 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34333 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34334 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34335 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34336 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34339 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34340 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34341 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34342 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34343 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34344 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34345 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34347 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34348 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34349 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34350 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34351 then to be treated as a host error.
34353 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34354 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34355 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34356 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34357 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34362 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34363 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34364 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34367 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34368 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34369 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34371 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34373 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34374 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34375 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34376 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34377 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34378 stream and exits with an error code.
34380 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34381 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34382 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34383 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34385 .cindex "carriage return"
34387 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34388 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34389 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34391 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34392 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34393 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34395 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34396 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34397 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34398 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34399 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34400 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34401 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34402 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34404 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34405 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34406 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34407 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34408 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34409 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34410 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34411 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34412 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34414 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34415 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34416 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34418 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34419 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34420 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34421 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34422 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34424 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34425 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34426 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34427 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34428 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34429 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34430 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34432 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34433 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34434 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34435 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34436 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34438 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34439 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34440 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34441 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34442 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34443 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34444 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34445 a delivery process.
34447 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34448 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34449 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34450 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34451 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34453 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34454 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34455 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34456 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34458 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34459 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34460 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34464 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34465 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34466 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34467 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34468 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34469 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34470 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34471 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34474 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34475 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34476 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34477 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34478 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34479 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34480 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34481 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34482 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34483 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34484 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34488 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34489 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34490 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34491 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34492 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34493 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34494 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34495 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34497 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34498 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34499 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34500 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34501 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34504 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34505 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34506 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34508 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34509 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34510 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34511 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34512 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34517 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34518 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34519 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34520 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34522 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34523 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34524 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34525 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34526 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34527 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34528 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34529 SMTP response codes.
34531 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34532 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34533 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34534 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34535 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34536 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34537 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34538 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34543 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34544 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34545 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34546 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34547 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34548 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34549 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34551 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34552 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34553 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34554 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34555 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34556 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34557 argument. For example,
34565 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34566 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34567 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34568 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34569 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34571 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34572 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34573 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34574 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34575 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34576 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34577 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34578 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34580 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34581 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34582 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34583 whatever the form of its argument. For
34586 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34587 $sender_host_address
34589 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34590 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34591 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34592 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34593 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34594 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34595 for it to change them before running the command.
34599 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34600 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34601 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34602 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34603 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34604 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34605 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34606 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34607 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34608 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34609 runs for RCPT commands:
34613 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34617 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34618 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34619 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34620 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34621 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34622 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34623 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34624 envelope along with the message.
34626 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34627 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34628 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34629 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34630 can be used to specify it.
34632 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34633 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34634 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34635 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34636 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34639 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34640 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34641 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34646 driver = manualroute
34647 transport = smtp_appendfile
34648 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34652 driver = appendfile
34653 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34658 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34659 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34660 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34664 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34665 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34666 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34667 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34668 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34669 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34670 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34671 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34672 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34673 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34675 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34676 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34678 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34679 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34680 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34681 make some use of automatically, for example:
34683 554 Unexpected end of file
34684 Transaction started in line 10
34685 Error detected in line 14
34687 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34690 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34691 The error message was:
34693 501 '>' missing at end of address
34695 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34696 The error was detected in line 12.
34697 The SMTP command at fault was:
34699 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34701 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34702 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34704 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34705 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34707 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34708 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34715 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34716 "Customizing messages"
34717 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34718 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34719 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34720 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34721 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34723 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34724 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34725 option. Exim also adds the line
34727 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34729 to all warning and bounce messages,
34732 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34733 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34734 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34735 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34736 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34737 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34738 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34740 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34741 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34742 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34743 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34744 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34747 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34748 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34749 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34750 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34751 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34752 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34753 option, rounded to a whole number.
34755 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34758 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34759 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34761 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34762 failing addresses with their error messages.
34764 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34765 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34767 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34768 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34771 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34772 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34773 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34775 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34776 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34777 {: returning message to sender}}
34779 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34781 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34782 {that you sent }{sent by
34786 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34787 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34789 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34791 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34794 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34796 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34799 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34800 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34801 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34802 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34803 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34807 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34808 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34810 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34811 the delayed addresses.
34813 The third item then ends the message.
34816 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34817 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34819 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34820 $warn_message_delay
34822 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34824 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34825 {that you sent }{sent by
34829 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34830 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34832 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34833 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34834 The date of the message is: $h_date
34836 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34838 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34839 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34840 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34841 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34842 the message will be returned to you.
34844 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34845 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34846 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34847 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34848 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34849 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34850 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34851 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34858 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34860 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34861 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34862 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34866 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34867 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34868 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34869 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34870 routing explicitly:
34872 send_to_smart_host:
34873 driver = manualroute
34874 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34875 transport = remote_smtp
34877 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34878 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34879 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34880 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34881 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34886 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34887 .cindex "mailing lists"
34888 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34889 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34890 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34892 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34893 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34894 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34895 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34899 domains = lists.example
34900 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34903 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34906 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34907 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34908 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34909 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34911 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34912 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34915 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34916 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34917 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34918 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34919 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34921 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34922 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34923 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34924 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34925 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34926 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34927 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34928 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34929 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34933 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34934 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34935 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34936 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34937 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34938 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34939 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34941 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34942 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34943 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34944 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34945 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34949 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34950 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34951 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34952 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34953 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34954 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34955 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34956 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34957 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34958 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34960 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34961 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34962 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34963 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34964 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34965 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34966 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34967 pre-existing messages.
34969 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34970 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34971 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34972 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34973 one level of expansion anyway.
34977 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34978 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34979 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34980 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34981 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34982 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34984 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34985 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34989 domains = lists.example
34990 local_part_suffix = -request
34991 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34996 domains = lists.example
34997 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34998 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34999 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35002 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35007 domains = lists.example
35009 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35011 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35012 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35013 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35016 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35017 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35018 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35019 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35020 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35021 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35022 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35023 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35024 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35026 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35027 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35028 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35033 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35035 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35036 .cindex "envelope sender"
35037 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35038 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35039 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35040 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35041 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35042 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35044 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35045 .oindex &%return_path%&
35046 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35047 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35048 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35049 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35050 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35051 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35052 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35058 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35059 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35061 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35062 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35063 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35064 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35065 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35066 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35067 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35070 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35072 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35073 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35074 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35075 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35076 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35077 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35079 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35080 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35081 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35082 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35086 domains = ! +local_domains
35088 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35089 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35092 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35093 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35094 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35095 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35098 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35099 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35100 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35101 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35102 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35106 domains = ! +local_domains
35107 transport = remote_smtp
35109 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35110 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35113 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35114 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35115 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35116 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35119 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35120 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35121 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35122 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35123 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35124 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35132 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35133 .cindex "virtual domains"
35134 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35135 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35139 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35140 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35141 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35143 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35144 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35145 have login accounts on that host.
35148 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35149 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35150 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35151 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35152 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35153 to a router of this form:
35157 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35158 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35161 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35162 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35163 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35164 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35165 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35166 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35168 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35169 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35170 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35171 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35173 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35174 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35175 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35179 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35180 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35181 transport = my_mailboxes
35183 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35184 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35185 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35186 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35187 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35191 driver = appendfile
35192 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35195 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35196 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35198 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35199 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35200 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35201 information about the domains.
35205 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35206 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35207 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35208 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35209 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35210 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35211 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35212 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35213 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35214 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35215 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35216 example, consider this router:
35221 file = $home/.forward
35222 local_part_suffix = -*
35223 local_part_suffix_optional
35226 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35227 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35228 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35229 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35231 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35232 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35235 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35236 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35237 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35238 control over which suffixes are valid.
35240 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35241 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35247 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35248 local_part_suffix = -*
35249 local_part_suffix_optional
35252 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35253 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35254 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35255 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35256 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35260 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35261 .cindex "vacation processing"
35262 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35263 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35264 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35265 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35266 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35269 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35270 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35271 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35272 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35274 spqr, vacation-spqr
35277 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35278 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35279 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35280 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35281 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35285 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35286 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35290 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35291 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35292 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35293 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35294 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35295 each day's messages.
35297 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35298 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35299 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35300 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35304 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35305 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35306 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35307 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35308 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35309 permanently connected.
35311 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35312 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35313 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35316 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35317 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35318 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35319 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35320 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35321 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35322 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35323 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35325 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35326 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35327 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35328 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35329 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35330 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35333 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35334 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35335 intermittent host. For example:
35337 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35339 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35340 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35341 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35342 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35343 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35344 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35347 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35348 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35349 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35350 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35351 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35352 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35353 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35357 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35358 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35359 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35360 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35361 delivered immediately.
35363 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35364 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35365 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35366 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35367 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35368 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35369 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35370 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35371 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35372 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35373 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35374 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35375 single SMTP connection.
35379 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35382 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35383 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35384 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35385 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35386 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35387 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35388 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35389 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35390 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35391 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35394 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35395 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35396 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35397 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35398 email is not desirable.
35400 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35401 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35402 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35403 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35404 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35405 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35406 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35408 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35409 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35410 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35411 before sending a message to the smart host.
35413 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35414 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35415 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35417 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35418 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35419 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35420 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35421 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35422 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35423 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35425 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35429 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35430 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35432 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35433 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35434 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35435 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35436 successful, a zero return code is given.
35438 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35439 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35440 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35441 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35442 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35445 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35446 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35447 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35449 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35450 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35451 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35452 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35453 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35455 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35456 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35457 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35459 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35460 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35461 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35462 are ever generated.
35464 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35466 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35467 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35468 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35471 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35472 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35473 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35474 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35475 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35476 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35484 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35485 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35486 .cindex "log" "types of"
35487 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35492 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35493 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35494 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35495 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35496 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35497 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35498 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35499 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35501 .cindex "reject log"
35502 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35503 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35504 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35505 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35506 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35507 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35508 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35509 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35510 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35513 .cindex "panic log"
35514 .cindex "system log"
35515 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35516 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35517 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35518 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35519 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35520 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35521 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35522 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35523 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35526 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35527 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35528 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35530 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35533 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35534 ways of changing this:
35537 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35542 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35544 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35547 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35551 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35552 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35553 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35554 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35555 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35556 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35561 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35562 .cindex "log" "destination"
35563 .cindex "log" "to file"
35564 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35566 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35567 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35568 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35569 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35570 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35571 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35572 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35574 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35575 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35576 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35577 references to the host name:
35579 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35581 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35582 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35583 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35584 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35585 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35588 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35589 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35590 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35591 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35592 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35593 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35594 implying the use of a default path.
35596 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35597 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35598 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35599 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35600 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35601 equivalent to the setting:
35603 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35605 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35606 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35607 that is where the logs are written.
35609 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35610 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35612 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35614 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35615 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35616 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35617 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35619 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35624 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35625 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35626 .cindex "cycling logs"
35627 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35628 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35629 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35630 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35631 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35632 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35633 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35635 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35636 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35637 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35638 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35639 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35640 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35641 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35642 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35643 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35644 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35645 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35650 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35651 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35652 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35653 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35654 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35655 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35656 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35657 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35659 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35660 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35661 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35662 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35664 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35665 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35667 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35668 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35669 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35670 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35672 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35673 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35674 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35675 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35677 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35678 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35679 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35680 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35681 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35682 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35685 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35686 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35687 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35688 /var/log/exim/panic
35692 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35693 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35694 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35695 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35696 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35697 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35698 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35699 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35700 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35701 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35702 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35703 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35704 the time and host name to each line.
35705 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35708 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35710 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35712 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35715 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35716 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35717 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35718 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35720 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35721 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35722 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35723 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35724 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35725 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35726 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35727 RFC 3164, you should set
35729 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35731 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35732 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35734 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35735 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35736 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35737 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35738 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35739 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35740 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35741 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35742 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35744 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35745 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35746 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35747 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35750 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35753 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35754 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35755 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35756 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35758 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35759 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35760 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35761 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35762 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35763 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35765 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35766 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35767 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35770 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35772 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35773 without modification.
35775 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35776 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35777 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35782 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35783 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35784 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35785 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35786 timestamp. The flags are:
35788 &`<=`& message arrival
35789 &`(=`& message fakereject
35790 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35791 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35792 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35793 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35794 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35795 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35799 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35800 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35801 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35802 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35803 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35805 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35806 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35807 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35809 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35810 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35811 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35815 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35819 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35820 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35821 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35822 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35823 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35824 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35825 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35826 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35827 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35828 name in parentheses.
35830 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35831 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35832 the log containing text like these examples:
35834 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35835 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35837 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35840 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35841 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35844 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35845 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35846 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35847 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35848 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35849 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35850 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35851 suite that was used.
35853 .cindex log protocol
35854 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35855 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35856 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35857 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35858 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35859 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35860 authenticator name.
35862 .cindex "size" "of message"
35863 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35864 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35865 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35866 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35869 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35870 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35874 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35875 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35876 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35877 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35878 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35879 to fit it on the page:
35881 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35882 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35883 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35884 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35885 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35887 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35888 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35889 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35890 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35891 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35893 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35894 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35895 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35896 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35898 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35899 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35901 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35903 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35904 parentheses afterwards.
35906 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35907 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35908 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35909 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35910 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35911 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35913 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
35914 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
35915 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35916 TLS cipher information is still available.
35919 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35920 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35921 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35922 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35923 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35925 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35926 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35928 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35929 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35932 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35933 .cindex "discarded messages"
35934 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35935 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35936 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35937 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35939 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35940 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35942 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35943 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35945 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35946 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35950 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35951 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35953 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35954 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35956 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35957 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35958 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35960 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35961 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35963 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35964 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35965 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35969 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35970 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35971 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35972 following form is logged:
35974 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35975 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35977 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35978 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35980 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35981 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35982 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35983 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35984 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35986 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35987 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35988 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35989 flagged with &`**`&.
35993 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35994 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35995 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35996 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35997 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36001 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36004 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36006 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36007 at the end of its processing.
36012 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36013 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36014 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36015 the following table:
36017 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36018 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36019 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36020 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36021 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36022 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36023 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36024 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36025 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36026 &`H `& host name and IP address
36027 &`I `& local interface used
36028 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36029 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36030 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36031 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36032 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36033 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36034 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36035 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36036 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36037 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36038 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36039 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36040 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36041 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36042 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36043 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36044 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36045 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36046 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36047 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36051 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36052 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36053 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36056 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36057 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36058 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36059 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36060 during the first delivery attempt.
36062 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36063 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36064 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36066 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36067 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36068 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36069 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36070 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36073 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36074 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36077 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36078 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36080 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36081 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36083 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36084 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36085 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36089 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36097 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36098 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36099 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36100 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36101 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36104 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36106 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36107 selection marked by asterisks:
36109 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36110 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36111 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36112 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36113 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36114 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36115 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36116 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36117 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36118 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36119 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36120 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36121 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36122 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36123 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36124 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36125 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36126 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and QT,DT,D times
36127 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36128 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36129 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36130 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36131 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36132 &` pid `& Exim process id
36133 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36134 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36135 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36136 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36137 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36138 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36139 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36140 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36141 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36142 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36143 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36144 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36145 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36146 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36147 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36148 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36149 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36150 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36151 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36152 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36153 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36154 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36155 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36157 &` all `& all of the above
36159 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36160 section &<<SECID99>>&
36162 More details on each of these items follows:
36166 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36167 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36168 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36169 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36170 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36171 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36173 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36174 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36175 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36176 this log selector is set.
36178 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36179 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36180 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36181 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36182 such users cannot access the log).
36184 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36185 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36186 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36187 parentheses between them.
36189 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36190 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36191 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36192 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36193 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36194 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36195 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36196 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36197 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36198 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36199 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36200 between the caller and Exim.
36202 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36203 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36204 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36206 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36207 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36208 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36209 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36210 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36211 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36213 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36214 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36215 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36216 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36217 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304`&.
36219 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36220 .cindex "size" "of message"
36221 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36222 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36224 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36225 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36226 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36227 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36228 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36231 .cindex dnssec logging
36232 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36233 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36234 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36235 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36236 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36238 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36239 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36240 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36241 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36242 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36243 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36245 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36246 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36247 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36248 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36249 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36251 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36252 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36253 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36254 client's ident port times out.
36256 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36257 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36258 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36259 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36260 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36261 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36262 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36263 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36264 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36265 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36266 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36268 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36269 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36270 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36271 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36272 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36273 on a proxied connection
36274 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36275 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36277 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36278 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36279 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36280 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36281 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36282 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36283 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36284 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36285 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36286 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36287 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36289 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36290 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36291 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36294 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36295 .cindex millisecond logging
36296 .cindex timstamps "millisecond, in logs"
36297 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36298 appended to the seconds value.
36301 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36302 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36303 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36304 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36305 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36306 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36307 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36308 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36309 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36311 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36312 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
36313 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36314 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36315 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36316 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36317 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36318 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36319 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36320 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36322 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36323 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36324 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36325 immediately after the time and date.
36327 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36328 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36329 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36331 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36332 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36333 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36334 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36335 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36336 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36337 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36338 message has been successfully received.
36339 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36340 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36342 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36343 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36344 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36345 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36347 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36348 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36349 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36350 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36351 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36353 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36356 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36357 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36358 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36359 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36361 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36362 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36363 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36364 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36365 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36367 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36368 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36369 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36370 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36373 .cindex "log" "return path"
36374 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36375 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36376 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36377 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36379 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36380 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36381 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36382 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36383 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36385 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36386 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36387 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36388 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36391 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36392 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36395 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36396 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36397 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36398 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36400 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36401 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36403 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36404 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36405 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36406 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36407 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36408 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36411 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36412 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36413 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36414 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36415 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36416 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36417 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36418 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36419 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36420 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36422 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36423 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36424 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36425 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36426 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36427 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36428 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36429 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36431 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36432 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36433 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36434 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36435 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36436 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36438 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36439 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36440 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36441 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36442 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36443 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36444 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36445 already have their own log lines.
36447 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36448 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36449 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36450 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36451 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36452 the same logging options.
36454 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36455 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36459 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36460 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36461 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36462 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36463 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36465 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36466 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36467 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36468 was accepted or used.
36470 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36471 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36472 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36473 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36474 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36475 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36476 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36477 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36479 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36480 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36481 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36482 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36483 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36484 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36485 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36486 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36487 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36489 .cindex "log" "subject"
36490 .cindex "subject, logging"
36491 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36492 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36493 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36494 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36495 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36497 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36498 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36499 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36500 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36502 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36503 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36504 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36505 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36507 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36508 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36509 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36510 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36511 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36513 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36514 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36515 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36516 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36517 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36519 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36520 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36521 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36525 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36526 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36527 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36528 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36529 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36530 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36531 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36532 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36533 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36534 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36535 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36536 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36537 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36539 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36540 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36541 &%message_logs%& option false.
36547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36550 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36551 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36552 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36553 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36554 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36556 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36557 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36558 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36559 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36560 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36561 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36562 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36564 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36565 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36566 "extract statistics from the log"
36567 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36568 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36569 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36570 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36571 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36572 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36573 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36574 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36577 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36578 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36579 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36584 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36585 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36586 .cindex "process, querying"
36588 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36589 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36590 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36591 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36592 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36593 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36594 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36595 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36597 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36598 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36599 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36602 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36603 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36604 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36605 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36606 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36609 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36610 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36611 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36612 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36614 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36616 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36617 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36618 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36619 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36620 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36621 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36623 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36624 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36628 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36629 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36630 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36631 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36635 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36639 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36640 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36642 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36643 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36646 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36647 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36648 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36652 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36653 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36654 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36656 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36657 Match against the size field.
36659 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36660 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36662 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36663 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36666 Match only frozen messages.
36669 Match only non-frozen messages.
36672 The following options control the format of the output:
36676 Display only the count of matching messages.
36679 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36683 Display message ids only.
36686 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36689 Display messages in reverse order.
36692 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36695 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36699 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36700 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36701 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36702 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36703 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36704 running a command such as
36706 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36708 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36709 it, as in the following example:
36711 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36713 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36714 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36715 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36716 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36718 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36719 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36720 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36721 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36722 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36723 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36726 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36727 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36728 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36729 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36730 level"& addresses).
36735 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36737 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36738 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36739 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36740 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36741 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36742 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36743 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36744 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36745 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36746 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36748 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36750 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36752 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36753 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36754 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36756 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36757 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36758 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36759 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36760 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36762 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36763 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36764 regular expression.
36766 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36767 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36769 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36770 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36774 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36775 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36776 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36777 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36778 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36779 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36782 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36783 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36784 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36785 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36786 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36789 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36790 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36791 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36792 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36793 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
36794 the &%--help%& option.
36797 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36798 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36799 .cindex "cycling logs"
36800 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36801 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36802 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36803 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36804 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36805 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36806 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36808 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36809 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36811 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36812 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36813 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36817 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36818 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36819 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36820 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36821 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36822 logs are handled similarly.
36824 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36825 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36826 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36827 any existing log files.
36829 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36830 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36831 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36832 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36833 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36835 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36837 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36838 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36842 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36843 .cindex "statistics"
36844 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36845 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36846 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36847 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36848 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36850 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36851 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36852 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36853 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36854 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36856 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36858 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36859 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36860 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36861 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36862 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36863 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36864 also produced per user.
36866 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36867 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36868 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36869 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36870 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36872 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36873 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36874 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36875 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36876 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36877 an entirely separate message.
36879 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36880 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36881 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36882 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36883 least one address that failed.
36885 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36886 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36887 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36888 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36889 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36890 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36891 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36893 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36894 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36895 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36897 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36898 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36899 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36901 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36904 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36905 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36906 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36907 .cindex "checking access"
36908 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36909 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36910 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36911 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36912 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36913 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36915 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36916 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36918 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36920 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36921 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36922 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36923 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36926 550 Relay not permitted
36928 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36929 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36930 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36931 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36934 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36935 -f himself@there.example
36937 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36938 mandatory arguments.
36940 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36941 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36942 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36946 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36947 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36948 .cindex "building DBM files"
36949 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36950 .cindex "lower casing"
36951 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36952 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36953 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36954 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36955 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36956 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36958 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36959 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36960 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36961 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36964 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36965 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36966 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36970 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36971 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36972 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36973 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36975 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36977 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36978 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36980 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36981 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36982 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36983 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36984 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36985 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36987 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36988 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36989 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36990 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36991 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36992 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36993 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36999 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37000 .cindex "retry" "times"
37001 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37002 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37003 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37004 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37005 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37006 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37007 output. For example:
37009 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37010 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37011 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37012 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37013 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37014 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37015 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37016 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37017 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37018 past final cutoff time
37020 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37021 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37022 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37023 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37024 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37025 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37028 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37029 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37030 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37031 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37032 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37033 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37037 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37038 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37039 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37040 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37041 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37042 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37043 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37046 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37048 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37051 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37053 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37055 &'misc'&: other hints data
37058 The &'misc'& database is used for
37061 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37063 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37064 &(smtp)& transport)
37066 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37072 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37073 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37074 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37075 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37076 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37078 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37080 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37082 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37083 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37085 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37086 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37087 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37088 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37089 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37090 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37091 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37092 and a textual description of the error.
37094 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37095 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37096 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37099 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37100 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37101 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37102 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37103 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37104 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37109 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37110 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37111 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37112 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37113 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37114 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37115 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37116 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37117 updated sufficiently often.
37119 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37120 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37121 the retry database:
37123 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37125 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37126 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37127 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37128 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37129 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37130 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37131 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37132 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37133 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37134 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37135 whenever it removes information from the database.
37137 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37138 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37139 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37140 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37141 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37143 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37144 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37145 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37146 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37147 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37148 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37149 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37152 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37153 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37158 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37159 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37160 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37161 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37162 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37163 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37164 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37167 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37168 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37169 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37170 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37171 by new data, for example:
37175 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37176 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37177 used as optional separators.
37182 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37183 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37184 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37185 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37186 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37187 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37188 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37189 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37190 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37191 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37192 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37193 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37194 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37198 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37201 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37204 .vitem &%-interval%&
37205 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37206 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37208 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37209 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37212 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37215 Suppress verification output.
37217 .vitem &%-retries%&
37218 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37219 the lock (default 10).
37221 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37222 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37223 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37224 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37227 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37228 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37229 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37230 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37233 Generate verbose output.
37236 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37237 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37238 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37239 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37240 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37241 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37242 more than 30 minutes old.
37244 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37245 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37246 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37247 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37248 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37249 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37251 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37252 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37253 suppresses all output except error messages.
37257 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37259 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37261 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37262 <&'some commands'&>
37265 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37266 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37269 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37270 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37272 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37273 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37280 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37281 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37282 .cindex "X-windows"
37283 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37284 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37285 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37286 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37287 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37288 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37289 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37290 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37294 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37295 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37296 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37297 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37298 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37299 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37300 parameters are for.
37302 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37303 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37304 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37306 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37308 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37309 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37310 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37311 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37312 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37314 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37315 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37317 Eximon*background: gray94
37319 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37320 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37321 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37322 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37323 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37324 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37325 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37328 Eximon*highlight: gray
37331 .cindex "admin user"
37332 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37333 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37335 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37336 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37337 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37338 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37339 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37341 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37342 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37343 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37344 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37345 different parts of the display.
37350 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37351 .cindex "stripchart"
37352 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37353 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37354 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37355 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37356 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37357 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37358 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37359 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37360 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37362 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37363 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37364 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37365 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37367 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37368 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37369 to a single partition.
37371 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37372 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37373 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37374 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37375 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37376 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37377 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37382 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37383 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37384 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37385 .cindex "window size"
37386 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37387 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37388 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37389 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37390 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37391 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37393 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37394 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37395 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37396 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37398 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37399 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37400 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37401 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37402 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37403 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37405 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37406 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37407 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37411 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37412 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37413 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37414 the main log is maintained.
37415 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37416 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37417 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37418 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37419 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37421 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37422 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37423 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37424 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37425 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37426 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37427 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37428 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37429 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37430 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37431 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37433 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37434 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37435 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37436 It cannot go further back up the log.
37438 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37439 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37440 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37441 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37442 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37443 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37445 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37446 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37447 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37448 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37449 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37450 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37452 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37453 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37454 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37455 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37456 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37457 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37458 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37459 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37460 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37465 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37466 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37467 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37468 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37469 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37470 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37471 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37472 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37473 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37474 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37476 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37477 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37478 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37479 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37480 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37481 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37482 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37484 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37485 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37486 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37487 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37488 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37489 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37490 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37492 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37493 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37494 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37495 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37497 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37498 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37499 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37500 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37501 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37502 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37503 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37506 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37507 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37509 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37510 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37511 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37512 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37513 display is updated.
37517 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37518 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37519 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37520 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37521 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37524 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37525 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37526 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37527 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37528 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37530 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37532 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37536 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37537 in a new text window.
37539 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37540 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37541 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37543 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37544 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37545 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37546 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37548 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37549 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37550 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37551 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37552 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37554 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37555 that the message be frozen.
37557 .cindex "thawing messages"
37558 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37559 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37560 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37561 that the message be thawed.
37563 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37564 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37565 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37566 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37568 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37569 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37572 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37573 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37574 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37575 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37576 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37577 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37578 which case no action is taken.
37580 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37581 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37582 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37583 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37584 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37585 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37586 case no action is taken.
37588 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37589 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37591 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37592 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37593 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37594 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37595 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37596 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37597 the address is qualified with that domain.
37600 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37601 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37602 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37603 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37604 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37605 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37606 if no output is generated.
37608 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37609 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37610 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37611 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37613 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37614 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37615 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37625 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37626 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37627 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37628 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37630 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37631 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37632 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37633 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37634 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37635 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37637 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37638 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37639 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37640 as soon as possible.
37643 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37644 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37645 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37646 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37647 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37648 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37651 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37652 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37653 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37654 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37655 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37656 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37658 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37659 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37660 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37661 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37664 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37665 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37666 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37667 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37668 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37669 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37670 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37671 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37672 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37676 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37677 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37678 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37679 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37680 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37681 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37682 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37684 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37687 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37688 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37689 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37690 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37691 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37696 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37698 .cindex "root privilege"
37699 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37700 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37701 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37702 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37703 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37704 is required for two things:
37707 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37708 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37711 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37712 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37716 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37717 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37718 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37719 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37720 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37721 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37722 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37723 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37725 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37726 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37727 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37729 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37730 uid and gid in the following cases:
37735 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37736 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37737 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37738 the calling process.
37739 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37740 option may not be used at all.
37741 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37742 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37743 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37748 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37749 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37752 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37753 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37754 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37755 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37756 testing address verification
37759 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37762 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37763 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37766 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37769 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37770 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37771 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37772 will be used during message reception.
37774 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37775 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37777 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37778 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37779 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37780 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37781 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37782 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37783 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37784 generating bounce and warning messages.
37786 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37787 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37788 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37789 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37791 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37792 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37798 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37799 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37800 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37801 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37802 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37803 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37804 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37805 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37806 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37807 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37811 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37812 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37813 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37814 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37816 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37817 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37818 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37819 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37820 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37822 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37823 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37824 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37827 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37828 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37829 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37831 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37832 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37833 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37834 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37835 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37836 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37837 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37838 address this problem at this time.
37840 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37841 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37842 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37843 be used in the most straightforward way.
37845 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37846 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37849 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37850 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37851 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37852 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37853 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37855 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37856 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37858 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37859 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37860 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37861 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37863 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37864 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37867 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37868 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37869 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37871 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37872 owned by the Exim user.
37874 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37875 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37876 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37881 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37882 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37883 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37884 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37886 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37887 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37892 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37893 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37894 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37898 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37899 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37900 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37901 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37902 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37903 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37904 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37907 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37908 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37909 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37910 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37911 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37913 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37914 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37915 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37916 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37917 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37918 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37919 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37921 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37922 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37923 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37925 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37926 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37928 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37929 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37930 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37932 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37933 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37934 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37936 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37937 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37938 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37939 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37945 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37946 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37947 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37948 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37949 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37950 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37951 are some issues to be aware of:
37954 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37956 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37958 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37959 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37960 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37961 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37962 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37963 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37966 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37967 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37968 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37970 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37971 expected to yield one result.
37977 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37978 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37979 .cindex "IP source routing"
37980 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37981 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37982 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37983 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37987 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37988 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37989 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37994 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37995 .cindex "trusted users"
37996 .cindex "admin user"
37997 .cindex "privileged user"
37998 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37999 .cindex "user" "admin"
38000 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38001 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38002 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38003 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38004 permit a remote host to be specified.
38007 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38008 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38009 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38010 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38011 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38012 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38014 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38015 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38016 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38017 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38018 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38020 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38021 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38022 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38023 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38024 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38028 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38029 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38030 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38031 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38032 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38033 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38035 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38036 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38037 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38038 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38039 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38040 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38044 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38045 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38046 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38047 This affects most of the checking options,
38048 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38052 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38053 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38054 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38055 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38056 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38057 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38061 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38062 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38063 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38064 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38065 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38070 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38071 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38072 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38073 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38078 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38079 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38080 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38081 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38082 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38086 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38087 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38088 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38092 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38093 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38094 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38095 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38096 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38097 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38098 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38100 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38101 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38106 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38107 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38108 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38109 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38113 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38114 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38115 enough to hold the result.
38116 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38122 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38124 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38125 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38126 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38127 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38128 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38129 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38130 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38131 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38132 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38133 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38134 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38135 themselves are recoverable.
38137 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38138 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38139 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38142 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38143 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38144 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38145 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38146 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38148 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38149 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38150 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38151 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38153 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38155 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38158 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38160 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38161 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38162 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38163 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38164 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38165 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38166 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38167 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38171 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38172 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38173 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38174 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38177 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38178 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38179 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38180 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38181 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38182 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38183 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38184 normally the Exim user.
38186 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38187 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38188 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38189 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38190 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38191 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38192 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38193 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38195 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38196 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38197 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38198 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38200 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38201 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38204 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38205 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38206 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38207 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38208 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38209 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38210 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38211 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38212 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38215 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38216 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38217 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38218 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38219 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38220 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38222 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38223 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38224 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38225 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38226 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38227 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38229 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38230 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38231 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38233 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38234 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38235 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38236 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38237 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38239 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38240 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38241 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38242 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38243 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38245 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38246 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38247 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38249 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38250 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38251 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38253 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38254 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38255 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38257 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38258 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38259 present if the number is greater than zero.
38261 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38262 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38263 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38265 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38266 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38267 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38269 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38270 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38273 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38274 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38275 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38278 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38279 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38280 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38281 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38283 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38284 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38285 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38287 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38288 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38289 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38290 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38291 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38292 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38294 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38295 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38296 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38297 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38298 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38300 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38301 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38302 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38303 generated messages.
38306 The message is from a local sender.
38308 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38309 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38311 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38312 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38313 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38314 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38316 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38317 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38318 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38321 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38322 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38325 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38326 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38327 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38329 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38330 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38331 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38333 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38334 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38335 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38338 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38339 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38340 rather than Unix-format.
38341 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38342 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38345 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38346 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38347 certificate was verified by the server.
38349 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38350 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38351 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38353 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38354 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38355 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38359 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38360 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38361 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38362 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38363 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38364 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38365 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38366 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38367 addresses are complete.
38369 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38370 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38371 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38372 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38373 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38374 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38376 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38377 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38378 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38380 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38381 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38382 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38383 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38387 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38388 darcy@austen.fict.example
38390 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38392 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38393 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38394 line is of the following form:
38396 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38397 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38399 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38400 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38401 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38402 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38403 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38404 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38405 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38406 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38409 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38410 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38411 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38412 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38413 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38417 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38418 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38419 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38420 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38421 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38422 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38423 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38424 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38425 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38426 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38429 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38430 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38431 typical set of headers:
38433 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38434 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38435 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38436 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38437 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38438 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38439 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38440 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38441 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38442 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38443 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38445 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38446 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38447 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38448 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38449 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38450 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38453 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38454 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38455 an ASCII newline character.
38456 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38457 can have an alternate format.
38458 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38459 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38460 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38461 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38462 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38463 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38469 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38473 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38474 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38475 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38476 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38478 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38479 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38481 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38483 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38484 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38485 (including transport filters)
38486 except cutthrough delivery.
38488 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38489 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38490 different signature contexts.
38493 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38494 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38495 Exim's standard controls.
38497 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38498 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38499 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38500 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38502 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38503 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38504 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38505 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38507 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38508 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38509 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38510 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38514 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38515 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38517 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38518 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38520 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38521 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38523 After expansion, this can be a list.
38524 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38525 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38527 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38529 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38530 This sets the key selector string.
38532 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38533 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38534 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38535 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38536 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain.
38539 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38540 This sets the private key to use.
38541 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38542 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38543 The result can either
38545 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38547 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38550 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38551 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38554 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38556 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38557 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38558 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38559 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38560 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38562 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38563 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38564 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38565 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38566 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38569 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38570 If set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38571 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38573 When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be used.
38576 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38577 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38578 method. Note that sha1 is now condidered insecure, and deprecated.
38582 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38583 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38585 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38586 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38587 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38588 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38589 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38590 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
38591 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38593 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38594 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38595 runtime of the ACL.
38597 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38598 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38599 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38600 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38602 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38603 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38604 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38605 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38606 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38607 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38610 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38612 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38613 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38614 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38616 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38618 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38619 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38620 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38622 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38625 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38626 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38629 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38630 available (from most to least important):
38634 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38635 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38636 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38637 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38639 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38640 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38642 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38643 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38645 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38646 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38648 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38649 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38651 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38654 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38655 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38656 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38658 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38659 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38661 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38662 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38664 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38665 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38666 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38668 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38669 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38670 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38671 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38674 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38675 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38676 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38677 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38679 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38680 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38681 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38682 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38684 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38685 The key record selector string.
38687 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38688 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38690 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38691 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38693 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
38694 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38696 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38697 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38698 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38699 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
38700 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
38701 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
38703 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38704 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38705 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38706 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38708 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38709 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38710 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38712 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38713 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38714 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38715 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38716 integer size comparisons against this value.
38718 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38719 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38721 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38722 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38724 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38725 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38727 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38728 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38731 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38732 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38735 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38736 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38738 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38739 Number of bits in the key.
38742 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38745 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38746 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38747 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38748 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38749 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38752 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
38753 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
38754 sender_domains = gmail.com
38755 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38759 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
38760 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
38762 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38763 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38764 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38765 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38768 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38769 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38770 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38771 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38774 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38775 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38776 for more information of what they mean.
38779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38780 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38782 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38784 .cindex "proxy support"
38785 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38787 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38788 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38791 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38792 .cindex proxy inbound
38793 .cindex proxy "server side"
38794 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38795 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38797 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38798 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38799 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38802 It was built on specifications from:
38803 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
38804 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38805 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
38807 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38808 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38809 to distribute load.
38810 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38811 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38812 There is no logging if a host passes or
38813 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38814 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38816 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38817 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38818 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38819 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
38820 automatically determines which version is in use.
38822 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
38823 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
38824 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
38825 Exim and the proxy server.
38827 The following expansion variables are usable
38828 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38831 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
38832 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
38833 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
38834 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
38835 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38837 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
38838 there was a protocol error.
38840 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38841 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38842 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38843 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38844 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38845 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38846 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38847 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38848 A possible solution is:
38850 # Set max number of connections per host
38852 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38853 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38855 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38856 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38861 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38862 .cindex proxy outbound
38863 .cindex proxy "client side"
38864 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38865 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38866 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38867 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38868 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38871 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38872 on an smtp transport.
38873 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38874 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38875 Each proxy specifier is a list
38876 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38877 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38879 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38880 The list of options is in the following table:
38882 &'auth '& authentication method
38883 &'name '& authentication username
38884 &'pass '& authentication password
38886 &'tmo '& connection timeout
38888 &'weight '& selection bias
38891 More details on each of these options follows:
38894 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38895 .cindex proxy authentication
38896 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38897 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38898 for access to the proxy.
38899 Default is &"none"&.
38901 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38904 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38907 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38910 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38913 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38914 higher values being tried first.
38915 The default priority is 1.
38917 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38918 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38919 weighted by this value.
38920 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38923 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38924 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38925 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38927 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
38928 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38929 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38930 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38933 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38935 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38936 "Internationalisation""
38937 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
38940 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38942 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38943 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38944 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38946 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
38947 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
38948 requirement, upon libidn2.
38950 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38951 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38952 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38953 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38954 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38955 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38957 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38958 international handling for the message is enabled and
38959 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38961 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38962 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38963 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38964 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38966 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38967 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38968 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38969 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38971 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38972 components expanded to a-label form,
38973 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38976 .cindex log protocol
38977 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38978 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38979 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38981 The following expansion operators can be used:
38983 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38984 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38985 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38986 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38989 ACLs may use the following modifier:
38991 control = utf8_downconvert
38992 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38994 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38995 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38996 Message Submission Agent context.
38997 If a value is appended it may be:
38999 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39000 &`0 `& no downconversion
39001 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39004 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39005 is initially set to -1.
39008 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39009 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39010 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39012 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39013 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39014 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39016 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39017 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39021 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39022 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39023 the following expansion operator can be used:
39025 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39028 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39029 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39030 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39032 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39033 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
39034 (which has to be a single character)
39035 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39036 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39038 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39039 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39041 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39042 by many other IMAP servers.
39046 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39047 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39048 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39051 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39052 must be representable in UTF-16.
39055 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39058 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39062 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39063 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39064 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39065 processing actions.
39067 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39068 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39069 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39071 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39072 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39073 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39075 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39076 An example might look like:
39077 .cindex logging custom
39079 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39080 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39081 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39082 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39083 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39084 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39085 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39086 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39087 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39091 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39092 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39093 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39095 The current list of events is:
39097 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39098 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39099 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39100 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39101 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39102 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39103 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39104 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39105 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39106 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39107 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39109 New event types may be added in future.
39111 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39112 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39113 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39115 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39116 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39117 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39120 The third column in the table above says what section of the configumration
39121 should define the event action.
39124 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39125 with the event type:
39127 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39128 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39129 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39130 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39131 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39132 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39135 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39137 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39138 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39139 the course of its processing:
39141 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39144 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39145 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39147 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39148 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39150 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39151 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39152 following will be forced:
39154 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
39155 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
39156 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
39157 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39158 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
39159 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39160 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39162 No other use is made of the result string.
39164 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39165 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39168 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39169 chain element received on the connection.
39170 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39176 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39177 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39178 .cindex "adding drivers"
39179 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39180 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39181 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39182 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39185 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39186 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39188 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39190 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39192 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39193 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39194 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39196 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39198 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39201 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39202 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39204 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39205 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39206 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39207 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39208 simple form that most lookups have.
39210 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39211 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39212 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39214 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39217 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39218 as for other drivers and lookups.
39221 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39222 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39223 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39224 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39225 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39227 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39228 the interface that is expected.
39233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39236 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39237 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39238 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39239 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39241 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39246 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39247 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39251 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39252 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39253 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39256 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39257 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////